blob: cd75de5669e1976a9bf837897d22487725f4824b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaufc0b8f32020-05-05 21:49:10 +02007 2020/05/05
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100604 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100607 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100609 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200610 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200612 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200613 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-options
627 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-options
630 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100631 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200632 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100633 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100634 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100635 - 51degrees-data-file
636 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200637 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200638 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-data-file
640 - wurfl-information-list
641 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100643 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100646 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200647 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200649 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100650 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100651 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200653 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200654 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200655 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200656 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - noepoll
658 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000659 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100661 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300662 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000663 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100664 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200665 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200666 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200667 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000668 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000669 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200670 - tune.buffers.limit
671 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200672 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200673 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100674 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200675 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200676 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200677 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100678 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200679 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200680 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100681 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100682 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100683 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.session-timeout
685 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200686 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100687 - tune.maxaccept
688 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200689 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200690 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200691 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100692 - tune.rcvbuf.client
693 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100694 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200695 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.sndbuf.client
697 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100698 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100699 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200700 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100701 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200702 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200703 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100704 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200705 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100706 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200707 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
708 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
709 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100710 - tune.zlib.memlevel
711 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713 * Debugging
714 - debug
715 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200716 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717
718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007193.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720------------------------------------
721
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200722ca-base <dir>
723 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100724 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
725 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
726 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200727
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728chroot <jail dir>
729 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
730 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
731 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
732 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
733 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100734 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100735
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100736cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
737 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
738 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
739 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
740 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
741 set. These sets have the format
742
743 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
744
745 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
748 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100749 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
750 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100753 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100755 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
756 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
757 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
758 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100759
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100760 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
761 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
762 on the machine's word size.
763
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100764 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
766 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
767 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
768 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
769 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
770 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771
772 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100773 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
774
775 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
776 # first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
779 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
780 # word size.
781
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100782 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100783 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100784 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
787
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
789 # and so on.
790 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
793
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100794 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100795 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
796 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
797 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
798
799 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
800 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
802
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100803 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
804 # and a thread range.
805 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
806 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
808
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200809crt-base <dir>
810 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100811 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
812 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200813
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200814daemon
815 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
816 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100817 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
818 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200820deviceatlas-json-file <path>
821 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100822 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823
824deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
827
828deviceatlas-separator <char>
829 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
830 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
831
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100832deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200833 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
834 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
835 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100836
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900837external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100838 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
839 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100840 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
841 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
842 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
843 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
844 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900845
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846gid <number>
847 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
848 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
849 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100850 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
851 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200852 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100853
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100854group <group name>
855 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
856 See also "gid" and "user".
857
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100858hard-stop-after <time>
859 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
860
861 Arguments :
862 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
863 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
864 SIGUSR1 signal.
865
866 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
867 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
868 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
869
870 Example:
871 global
872 hard-stop-after 30s
873
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200874h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
875 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
876 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
877 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
878 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500879 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200880 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
881 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
882 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
883 specified in a proxy.
884
885 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
886 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
887 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
888 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
889 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
890 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
891 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
892
893 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
894 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
895 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
896 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
897 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
898
899 Example:
900 global
901 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
902
903 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
904 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
905
906h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
907 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
908 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
909 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
910 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
911 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
912 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
913 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
914 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
915
916 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
917 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
918 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
919
920 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
921 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
922
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100923insecure-fork-wanted
924 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
925 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
926 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
927 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
928 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
929 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
930 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
931 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
932 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
933 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
934 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
935 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
936 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
937 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
938 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
939 disable it.
940
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100941insecure-setuid-wanted
942 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
943 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
944 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
945 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
946 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
947 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
948 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
949 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
950 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
951 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
952 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
953 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
954 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
955 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
956
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100957issuers-chain-path <dir>
958 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
959 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
960 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
961 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
962 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
963 "issuers-chain-path".
964 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
965 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
966 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
967 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
968 will share the chain in memory.
969
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200970log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
971 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100972 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100973 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100974 configured with "log global".
975
976 <address> can be one of:
977
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100978 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100979 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
980 port).
981
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100982 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
983 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
984 port).
985
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100986 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100987 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
988 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100989 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100990
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100991 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
992 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
993 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
994 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
995 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
996 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
997 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
998 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
999 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1000 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1001 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1002 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1003 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1004 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001005 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1006 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001007
1008 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1009 "fd@2", see above.
1010
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001011 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1012 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1013 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1014 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1015 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1016
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001017 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1018 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001019
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001020 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1021 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1022 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1023 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1024 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1025 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1026 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1027 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1028 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1029 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001030 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1031 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001033 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1034 one of the following :
1035
1036 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1037 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1038
1039 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1040 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1041
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001042 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1043 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1044 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1045 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1046 logger consumes.
1047
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001048 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1049 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1050 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1051 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1052
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001053 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1054 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1055 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1056 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1057 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1058
1059 <sample_size>
1060 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1061 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1062 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1063 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1064 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1065
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001066 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001068 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1069 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1070 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1071
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001072 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1073 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1074 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1075 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001078 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1079 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1080 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1081 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1082 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1083 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001085 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001087log-send-hostname [<string>]
1088 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1089 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1090 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1091 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1092 the logs.
1093
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001094log-tag <string>
1095 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1096 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1097 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001098 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001099
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001100lua-load <file>
1101 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1102 used multiple times.
1103
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001104lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1105 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1106 variable.
1107 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1108 to "path".
1109
1110 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1111 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1112 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1113 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1114 will be checked earlier.
1115
1116 As an example by specifying the following path:
1117
1118 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1120
1121 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1122 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1124 paths if that does not exist either.
1125
1126 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1127 documentation.
1128
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001129master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001130 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1131 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1132 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001133 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001134 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1135 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001136 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1137 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1138 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1139 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1140 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001141
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001142 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001143
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001144mworker-max-reloads <number>
1145 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001146 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001147 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1148 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1149 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1150
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001151nbproc <number>
1152 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1153 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1154 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001155 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1156 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001157 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1158 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001160nbthread <number>
1161 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001162 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1163 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1164 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1165 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1166 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001167 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1168 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1169 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1170 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1171 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1172 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1173 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001174
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001175pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001176 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1178 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1179
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001180presetenv <name> <value>
1181 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1182 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1183 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1184 and "unsetenv".
1185
1186resetenv [<name> ...]
1187 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1188 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1189 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1190 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1191 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1192 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1193 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1194 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1195
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001196stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001197 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1198 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1199 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1200 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1201 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1202 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001203 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001204 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1205 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1206 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1207 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001208
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001209server-state-base <directory>
1210 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001211 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1212 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001213
1214server-state-file <file>
1215 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1216 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1217 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1218 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1219 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1220 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1221 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1222 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001223 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1224 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001225
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001226setenv <name> <value>
1227 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1228 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1229 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1230 and "unsetenv".
1231
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001232set-dumpable
1233 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001234 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1235 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1236 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1237 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1238 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1239 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1240 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1241 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1242 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1243 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1244 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1245 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1246 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1247 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1248 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1249 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1250 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001251
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001252ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1254 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001255 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001256 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001257 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1258 information and recommendations see e.g.
1259 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1260 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1261 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1262 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001263
1264ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1266 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1267 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1268 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1269 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001270 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1271 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1272 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001273 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001274
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001275ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1277 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1278 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1279 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1280 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1281
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001282ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1284 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1285 keyword to see available options.
1286
1287 Example:
1288 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001289 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001290
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001291ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1293 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001294 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001295 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001296 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1297 information and recommendations see e.g.
1298 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1299 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1300 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1301 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1302 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001303
1304ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1306 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1307 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1308 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1309 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001310 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1311 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1312 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1313 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001314
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001315ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1317 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1318 keyword to see available options.
1319
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001320ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1322 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1323 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001324 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001325 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001326 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1327 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1328 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1329 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001330 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1331 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1332 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1333
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001334ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001335 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1336 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1337
1338 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1339 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1340 optimize the startup time.
1341
1342 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1343 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1344 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1345
1346 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001347 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001348
1349 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1350 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1351 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1352 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1353 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1354 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001355 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001356 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1357
1358 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1359
1360 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1361
1362 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1363 not provided in the PEM file.
1364
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001365 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1366 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1367
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001368 The default behavior is "all".
1369
1370 Example:
1371 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1372 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1373 ssl-load-extra-files none
1374
1375 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1376
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001377ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1378 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1379 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1380 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1381
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001382ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1383 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1384 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1385 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1386 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1387 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1388 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1389 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1390 bits does not need it.
1391
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001392stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1393 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1394 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1395 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001396 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001397 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001398
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001399 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1400 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1401 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001402
1403stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1404 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1405 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001406 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001407
1408stats maxconn <connections>
1409 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1410 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1411
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001412uid <number>
1413 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1414 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1415 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1416 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1417
1418ulimit-n <number>
1419 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1420 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1421 option.
1422
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001423unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1424 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1425
1426 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1427 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1428 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1429 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1430 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1431 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1432 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1433 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1434 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1435 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1436
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001437unsetenv [<name> ...]
1438 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1439 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1440 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1441 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1442 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1443 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1444 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1445
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446user <user name>
1447 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1448 See also "uid" and "group".
1449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001450node <name>
1451 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1452
1453 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1454 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1455 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1456 traffic.
1457
1458description <text>
1459 Add a text that describes the instance.
1460
1461 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1462 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1463 "<" and ">" characters.
1464
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146551degrees-data-file <file path>
1466 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001467 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001468
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001469 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001470 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1471
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001473 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1474 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1475 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1476
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001477 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001478 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1479
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001481 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1482 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1483
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001484 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1485 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1486
148751degrees-cache-size <number>
1488 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1489 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1490 By default, this cache is disabled.
1491
1492 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001493 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1494
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001495wurfl-data-file <file path>
1496 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1497 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1498
1499 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1500 with USE_WURFL=1.
1501
1502wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1503 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1504 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1505 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1506
1507 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1508
1509 Valid WURFL properties are:
1510 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1511
1512 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1513 device.
1514
1515 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1516 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1517
1518 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1519 particular web request.
1520
1521 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1522 used Libwurfl API version.
1523
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001524 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1525 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1526
1527 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1528 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1529
1530 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1531
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001532 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1533 with USE_WURFL=1.
1534
1535wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1536 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1537 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1538
1539 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1540 with USE_WURFL=1.
1541
1542wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1543 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1544 thus before the chroot.
1545
1546 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1547 with USE_WURFL=1.
1548
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001549wurfl-cache-size <size>
1550 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1551 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001552 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001553 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001554
1555 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1556 with USE_WURFL=1.
1557
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001558strict-limits
1559 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1560 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1561 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1562 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1563 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1564 keyword.
1565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015663.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567-----------------------
1568
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001569busy-polling
1570 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1571 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1572 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1573 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1574 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1575 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1576 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1577 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1578 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1579 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1580 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1581 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1582 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1583 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1584 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1585 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1586 "poll" pollers.
1587
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001588 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1589 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1590 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1591
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001592max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1593 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1594 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1595 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1596 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1597 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1598 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1599 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1600 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1601
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001602maxconn <number>
1603 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1604 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1605 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001606 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1607 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1608 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1609 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001610 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1611 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1612 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1613 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1614 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1615 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001617maxconnrate <number>
1618 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1619 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1620 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1621 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1622 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1623 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1624 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1625 fairness.
1626
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001627maxcomprate <number>
1628 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001629 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001630 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1631 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1632 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001633 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001634 default value.
1635
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001636maxcompcpuusage <number>
1637 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1638 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1639 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1640 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1641 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1642 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1643 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1644 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1645
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001646maxpipes <number>
1647 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1648 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1649 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1650 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1651 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1652 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1653
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001654maxsessrate <number>
1655 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1656 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1657 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1658 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1659 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1660 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1661 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1662 fairness.
1663
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001664maxsslconn <number>
1665 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1666 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1667 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1668 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1669 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1670 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1671 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001672 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1673 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1674 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1675 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1676 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1677 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1678 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001679
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001680maxsslrate <number>
1681 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1682 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1683 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1684 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1685 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1686 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1687 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1688 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1689 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1690 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1691
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001692maxzlibmem <number>
1693 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1694 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1695 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001696 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1697 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1698 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001700noepoll
1701 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1702 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001703 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001704
1705nokqueue
1706 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1707 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1708 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1709
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001710noevports
1711 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1712 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1713 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1714 also "nopoll".
1715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001716nopoll
1717 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1718 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001720 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1721 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001722
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001723nosplice
1724 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001725 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001726 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001727 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001728 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1729 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1730 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1731 "option splice-response".
1732
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001733nogetaddrinfo
1734 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1735 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1736
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001737noreuseport
1738 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1739 command line argument "-dR".
1740
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001741profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1742 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1743 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1744 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1745 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001746 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001747 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1748 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1749 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1750 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1751
1752 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1753 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1754 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1755 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1756 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001757 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1758 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1759 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1760 CLI.
1761
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001762spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001763 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1764 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1765 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1766 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1767 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1768 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001770ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001771 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001772 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001773 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1774 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1775 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1776 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1777 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001778 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1779 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001780 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1781 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1782 openssl configuration file uses:
1783 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1784
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001785ssl-mode-async
1786 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001787 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001788 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1789 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1790 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001791 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001792 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001793
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001794tune.buffers.limit <number>
1795 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1796 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1797 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1798 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1799 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001800 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001801 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1802 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1803 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1804 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1805 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1806 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1807 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1808 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1809 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1810
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001811tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1812 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1813 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1814 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1815 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1816
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001817tune.bufsize <number>
1818 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1819 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1820 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1821 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1822 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1823 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1824 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001825 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1826 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1827 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001828 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001829 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1830 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1831 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001832
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001833tune.chksize <number>
1834 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1835 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1836 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1837 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1838 checks whenever possible.
1839
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001840tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1841 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1842 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1843 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1844 this value. The default value is 1.
1845
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001846tune.fail-alloc
1847 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1848 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1849 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1850 gracefully.
1851
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001852tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1853 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1854 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1855 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1856 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1857 change it.
1858
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001859tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1860 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001861 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1862 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001863 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1864 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1865 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1866 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1867 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1868
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001869tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1870 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1871 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1872 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1873 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1874 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1875 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1876 recommended not to change this value.
1877
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001878tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1879 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1880 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1881 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1882 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1883 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1884 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1885 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1886
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001887tune.http.cookielen <number>
1888 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1889 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1890 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1891 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1892 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1893 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1894 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1895 to change this value.
1896
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001897tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1899 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001900 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001901 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001902 configuration directives too.
1903 The default value is 1024.
1904
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001905tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1906 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1907 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1908 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1909 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1910 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1911 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001912 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1913 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1914 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001915
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001916tune.idletimer <timeout>
1917 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1918 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1919 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1920 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1921 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1922 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001923 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001924 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001925 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1926
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001927tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1928 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1929 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1930 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1931 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1932 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1933 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1934 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1935 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1936 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1937
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001938tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1939 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001940 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001941 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1942 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001943 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001944 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1945 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1946
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001947tune.lua.maxmem
1948 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1949 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1950 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1951 memory.
1952
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001953tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1954 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001955 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1956 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001957 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001958
1959tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1960 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1961 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1962 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1963 check servers.
1964
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001965tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1966 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1967 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1968 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001969 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001970
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001971tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001972 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1973 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1974 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1975 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1976 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1977 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1978 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1979 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1980 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1981 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001982
1983tune.maxpollevents <number>
1984 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1985 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1986 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1987 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1988 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1989
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001990tune.maxrewrite <number>
1991 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1992 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1993 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1994 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1995 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1996 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1997 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1998 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1999 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2000 bufsize.
2001
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002002tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2003 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2004 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2005 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2006 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2007 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2008 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2009 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2010 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2011 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002012 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2013 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002014 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2015 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2016 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2017 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2018 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2019 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2020 setting this parameter to 0.
2021
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002022tune.pipesize <number>
2023 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2024 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2025 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2026 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2027 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2028 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2029
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002030tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2031 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2032 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2033 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2034 default is 20.
2035
2036tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2037 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2038 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2039 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2040 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2041 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2042 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002043 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002044
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002045tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2046tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2047 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2048 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2049 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002050 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002051 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002052 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2053 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2054
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002055tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002056 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002057 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2058 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2059 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2060 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2061
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002062tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002063 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002064 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2065 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2066
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002067tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2068tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2069 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2070 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2071 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002072 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002074 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2075 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2076 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2077 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2078 notifying haproxy again.
2079
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002080tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002081 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2082 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2083 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002084 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002085 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002086 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002087 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2088 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2089 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002090 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2091 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002092
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002093tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002094 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002095 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2096 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2097 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2098 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2099 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2100
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002101tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2102 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002103 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002104 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2105 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2106 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2107 being used for too long.
2108
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002109tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2110 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2111 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2112 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2113 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2114 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2115 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2116 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2117 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2118 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2119 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002120 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002121 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002122
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002123tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2124 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2125 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2126 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2127 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002128 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002129 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2130 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002131 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2132 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002133
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002134tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2135 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2136 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2137 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2138 1000 entries.
2139
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002140tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2141 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2142 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2143 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2144
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002145tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002146tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002147tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2148tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002150 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2151 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2152 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2153 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2154 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2155 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2156 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2157 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002158
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002159 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2160 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2161 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2162 all available space is consumed.
2163 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2164 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2165 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002166
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002167tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2168 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002169 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002170 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002171 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002172 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2173
2174tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2175 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2176 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002177 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2178 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021803.3. Debugging
2181--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002182
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002183debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002184 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2185 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2186 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2187 system startup.
2188
2189quiet
2190 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2191 line argument "-q".
2192
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002193zero-warning
2194 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2195 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2196 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2197 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2198 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2199 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2200
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022023.4. Userlists
2203--------------
2204It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2205http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2206it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2207
2208userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002209 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002210 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2211
2212group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002213 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002214 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2215 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2216
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002217user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2218 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002219 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2220 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002221 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2222 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2223 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2224 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002225
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002226 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2227 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2228 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2229 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2230 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2231 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2232 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2233 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2234 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002235
2236 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002237 userlist L1
2238 group G1 users tiger,scott
2239 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002240
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002241 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2242 user scott insecure-password elgato
2243 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002244
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002245 userlist L2
2246 group G1
2247 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002248
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002249 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2250 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2251 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002252
2253 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002254
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002255
22563.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002257----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002258It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2259several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2260instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2261values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2262automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2263In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2264using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2265tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2266reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2267Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2268that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2269each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002270
2271peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002272 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002273 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2274
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002275bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2276 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2277 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2278
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002279disabled
2280 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2281 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2282 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2283
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002284default-bind [param*]
2285 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2286
2287default-server [param*]
2288 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2289
2290 Arguments:
2291 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2292 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2293 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2294 details.
2295
2296
2297 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2298
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002299enable
2300 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2301
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002302log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2303 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2304 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2305 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2306 more details.
2307
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002308peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002309 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2310 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2311 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2312 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2313 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2314 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2315
2316 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2317 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2318
2319 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2320 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2321 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2322 across all peers.
2323
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002324 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2325 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002326
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002327 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2328 "server" keyword explanation below).
2329
2330server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002331 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002332 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2333 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2334 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2335 of this "peers" section).
2336 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2337
2338
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002339 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002340 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002341 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002342 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2343 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2344 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002345
2346 backend mybackend
2347 mode tcp
2348 balance roundrobin
2349 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2350 stick on src
2351
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002352 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2353 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002354
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002355 Example:
2356 peers mypeers
2357 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2358 default-server ssl verify none
2359 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2360 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002361
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002362
2363table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2364 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2365
2366 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2367 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002368 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002369 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2370 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2371 "stick-table" keyword).
2372
2373 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2374 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2375 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2376 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2377 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2378 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2379 of the stick-table name as follows:
2380
2381 peers mypeers
2382 peer A ...
2383 peer B ...
2384 table t1 ...
2385
2386 frontend fe1
2387 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2388
2389 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2390 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2391
2392 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2393 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2394 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2395 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2396 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2397 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2398 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2399
2400 peers mypeers
2401 peer A ...
2402 peer B ...
2403 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2404
2405 backend t1
2406 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2407
2408 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2409 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2410 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2411
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024123.6. Mailers
2413------------
2414It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2415If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2416in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2417
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002418mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002419 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2420 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2421
2422mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2423 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2424
2425 Example:
2426 mailers mymailers
2427 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2428 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2429
2430 backend mybackend
2431 mode tcp
2432 balance roundrobin
2433
2434 email-alert mailers mymailers
2435 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2436 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2437
2438 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2439 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2440
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002441timeout mail <time>
2442 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2443 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2444 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2445 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2446
2447 Example:
2448 mailers mymailers
2449 timeout mail 20s
2450 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002451
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024523.7. Programs
2453-------------
2454In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2455master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2456managed the same way as the workers.
2457
2458During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2459sequence as a worker:
2460
2461 - the master is re-executed
2462 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2463 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2464 instance of the program
2465
2466During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2467
2468program <name>
2469 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2470 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2471 the management guide).
2472
2473command <command> [arguments*]
2474 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2475 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2476 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2477 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2478
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002479user <user name>
2480 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2481 See also "group".
2482
2483group <group name>
2484 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2485 See also "user".
2486
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002487option start-on-reload
2488no option start-on-reload
2489 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2490 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2491 program section.
2492
2493
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024943.8. HTTP-errors
2495----------------
2496
2497It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2498imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2499several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2500
2501http-errors <name>
2502 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2503 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2504
2505errorfile <code> <file>
2506 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2507
2508 Arguments :
2509 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2510 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2511 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2512
2513 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2514 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2515 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2516 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2517 before any chroot is performed.
2518
2519 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2520
2521 Example:
2522 http-errors website-1
2523 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2524 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2525 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2526
2527 http-errors website-2
2528 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2529 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2530 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2531
2532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025334. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002534----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002536Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002537 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002538 - frontend <name>
2539 - backend <name>
2540 - listen <name>
2541
2542A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2543its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2544section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002545section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002546
2547A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2548connections.
2549
2550A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2551to forward incoming connections.
2552
2553A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2554parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2557'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2558case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2559
2560Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2561logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2562proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2563However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2564name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2565
2566Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2567and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002568bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2570modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2571arbitrary criteria.
2572
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002573In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2574a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002575the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002576
2577 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2578 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2579 between responses and new requests.
2580
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002581 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2582 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2583 client-facing connection remains open.
2584
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002585 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2586 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002587
2588The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2589frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2590following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002591weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002592
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002593 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002594
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002595 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2596 ----+-----+-----+----
2597 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2598 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002599 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2600 ----+-----+-----+----
2601 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002602
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026054.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2606--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002608The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2609limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2610they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2611limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002612marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002613option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002614and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2615with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2616specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002617
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002618
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002619 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2620------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2621acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002622backlog X X X -
2623balance X - X X
2624bind - X X -
2625bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626capture cookie - X X -
2627capture request header - X X -
2628capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002629compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002630cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002631declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002632default-server X - X X
2633default_backend X X X -
2634description - X X X
2635disabled X X X X
2636dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002637email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002638email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002639email-alert mailers X X X X
2640email-alert myhostname X X X X
2641email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002642enabled X X X X
2643errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002644errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002645errorloc X X X X
2646errorloc302 X X X X
2647-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2648errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002649force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002650filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002651fullconn X - X X
2652grace X X X X
2653hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002654http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002655http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002656http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002657http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002658http-check expect X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002659http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002660http-check set-var X - X X
2661http-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002662http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002663http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002664http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002665http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002666id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002667ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002668load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002669log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002670log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002671log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002672log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002673max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002674maxconn X X X -
2675mode X X X X
2676monitor fail - X X -
2677monitor-net X X X -
2678monitor-uri X X X -
2679option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2680option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2681option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2682option allbackups (*) X - X X
2683option checkcache (*) X - X X
2684option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2685option contstats (*) X X X -
2686option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2687option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002688-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2689option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002690option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2691option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002692option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002693option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002694option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002695option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002696option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002697option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2698option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2699option httpchk X - X X
2700option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002701option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002702option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002703option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002704option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002705option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002706option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2707option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2708option logasap (*) X X X -
2709option mysql-check X - X X
2710option nolinger (*) X X X X
2711option originalto X X X X
2712option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002713option pgsql-check X - X X
2714option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002715option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002716option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002717option smtpchk X - X X
2718option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2719option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2720option splice-request (*) X X X X
2721option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002722option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002723option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2724option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2725-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002726option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002727option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2728option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2729option tcpka X X X X
2730option tcplog X X X X
2731option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002732external-check command X - X X
2733external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002734persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2735rate-limit sessions X X X -
2736redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002737-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002738retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002739retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002740server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002741server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002742server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002743source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002744stats admin - X X X
2745stats auth X X X X
2746stats enable X X X X
2747stats hide-version X X X X
2748stats http-request - X X X
2749stats realm X X X X
2750stats refresh X X X X
2751stats scope X X X X
2752stats show-desc X X X X
2753stats show-legends X X X X
2754stats show-node X X X X
2755stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002756-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2757stick match - - X X
2758stick on - - X X
2759stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002760stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002761stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002762tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002763tcp-check connect X - X X
2764tcp-check expect X - X X
2765tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002766tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002767tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002768tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002769tcp-check set-var X - X X
2770tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002771tcp-request connection - X X -
2772tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002773tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002774tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002775tcp-response content - - X X
2776tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002777timeout check X - X X
2778timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002779timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002780timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002781timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2782timeout http-request X X X X
2783timeout queue X - X X
2784timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002785timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002786timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002787timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002788transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002789unique-id-format X X X -
2790unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002791use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002792use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002793use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002794------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2795 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027984.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2799---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002800
2801This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2802
2803
2804acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2805 Declare or complete an access list.
2806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2807 no | yes | yes | yes
2808 Example:
2809 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2810 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2811 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002813 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002814
2815
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002816backlog <conns>
2817 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2819 yes | yes | yes | no
2820 Arguments :
2821 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2822 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002823 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002824
2825 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2826 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2827 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2828 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2829 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2830 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2831 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2832 backlog parameter.
2833
2834 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2835 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2836 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2837
2838 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2839
2840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002842balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002843 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 yes | no | yes | yes
2846 Arguments :
2847 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2848 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2849 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2850 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2851
2852 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2853 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2854 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2855 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002856 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002857 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002858 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2859 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2860 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2861 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2862 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2863 it, so that you don't worry.
2864
2865 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2866 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2867 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2868 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2869 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2870 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2871 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2872 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002873
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002874 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2875 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2876 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2877 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2878 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2879 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2880 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2881 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2882
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002883 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002884 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002885 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2886 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002887 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002888 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2889 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2890 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2891 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2892 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002893 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2894 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2895 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2896 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2897 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2898 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002900 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2901 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2902 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2903 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2904 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2905 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2906 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2907 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002908 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002909 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002910 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2911 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2912 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002913
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002914 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2915 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2916 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2917 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2918 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2919 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2920 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2921 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2922 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2923 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2924 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2925 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002926
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002927 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002928 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2929 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2930 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2931 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2932 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2933 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2934 URIs start with a leading "/".
2935
2936 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2937 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2938 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2939 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002941 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002942 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2943
2944 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002945 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2946 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002947 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2948 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2949 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2950 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002951 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002952 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2953 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002954
2955 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2956 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2957 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2958 server will receive the request.
2959
2960 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2961 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2962 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2963 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2964 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002965 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2966 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2967 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002968
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002969 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2970 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2971 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2972 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2973 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002975 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002976 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2977 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2978 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2979
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002980 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2981 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2982 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2983
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002984 random
2985 random(<draws>)
2986 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002987 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2988 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2989 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2990 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002991 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2992 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2993 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2994 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2995 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2996 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2997 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2998 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2999 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3000 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3001 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3002 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3003 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3004 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3005 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3006 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3007 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3008 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3009 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3010 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003011
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003012 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003013 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003014 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3015 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3016 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3017 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3018 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3019 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003020 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003021 used instead.
3022
3023 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3024 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3025 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3026 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3027
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003028 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3029 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3030 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3031
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003032 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003035 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3036 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003037
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003038 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3039 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3040 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003041
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003042 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003043 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003044 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3045 NTLM relies on.
3046
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003047 Examples :
3048 balance roundrobin
3049 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003050 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003051 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3052 balance hdr(host)
3053 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003054
3055 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3056 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003058 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003059 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3060 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3061 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003062 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003063
3064 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3065 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3066 defaults to 16 kB.
3067
3068 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3069 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3070
3071 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3072 Round Robin.
3073
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003074 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003075 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3076 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3077 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3078
3079 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3080
3081 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003082 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003083 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3084 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3085 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003086
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003087 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003088
3089
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003090bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3091bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003092 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3094 no | yes | yes | no
3095 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003096 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3097 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3098 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3099 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003100 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003101 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3102 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3103 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3104 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3105 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3106 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3107 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003108 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3109 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3110 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3111 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3112 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3113 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3114 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003115 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3116 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3117 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003118 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3119 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3120 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3121 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003122 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3123 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3124 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003125
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003126 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3127 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003128 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3129 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3130 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003131 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3132 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3133 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3134 the range.
3135
3136 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3137 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3138 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3139 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3140 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3141 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3142 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003143 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003144 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003146 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003147 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003148 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3149 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3150 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3151 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3152 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3153 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3154
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003155 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3156 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3157 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3158 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003159
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003160 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3161 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3162 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3163 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3164 in a frontend.
3165
3166 Example :
3167 listen http_proxy
3168 bind :80,:443
3169 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003170 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003171
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003172 listen http_https_proxy
3173 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003174 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003175
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003176 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3177 bind ipv6@:80
3178 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3179 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3180
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003181 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003182 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003183
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003184 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3185 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3186 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3187 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3188 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3189
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003190 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003191 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003192
3193
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003194bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003195 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3197 yes | yes | yes | yes
3198 Arguments :
3199 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3200 may be used to override a default value.
3201
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003202 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003203 option may be combined with other numbers.
3204
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003205 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003206 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3207 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3208 missing from all processes.
3209
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003210 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003211 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003212 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3213 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3214 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3215 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3216 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003217 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003218
3219 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3220 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3221 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3222 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3223 and 'even' instances.
3224
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003225 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3226 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3227 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3228 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003229
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003230 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3231 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3232
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003233 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3234 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3235 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3236
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003237 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3238 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3239
3240 Example :
3241 listen app_ip1
3242 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003243 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003244
3245 listen app_ip2
3246 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003247 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003248
3249 listen management
3250 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003251 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003252
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003253 listen management
3254 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3255 bind-process 1-4
3256
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003257 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003258
3259
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003260capture cookie <name> len <length>
3261 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3263 no | yes | yes | no
3264 Arguments :
3265 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3266 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3267 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3268 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003269 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003270
3271 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3272 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3273 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3274 right if it exceeds <length>.
3275
3276 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3277 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3278 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3279 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3280
3281 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3282 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3283 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3284
3285 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3286 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3287 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003288 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3289 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3290 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003291
3292 Example:
3293 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3294
3295 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003296 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003297
3298
3299capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003300 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3302 no | yes | yes | no
3303 Arguments :
3304 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003305 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3307 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3308 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3309
3310 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3311 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3312 it exceeds <length>.
3313
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003314 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003315 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3316 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003317 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3318 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3319 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3320 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003321 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003322 environments to find where the request came from.
3323
3324 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3325 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3326 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3327 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003328
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003329 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3330 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3331 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3332 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3333 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003334
3335 Example:
3336 capture request header Host len 15
3337 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003338 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003340 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003341 about logging.
3342
3343
3344capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003345 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3347 no | yes | yes | no
3348 Arguments :
3349 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003350 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003351 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3352 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3353 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3354
3355 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3356 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3357 it exceeds <length>.
3358
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003359 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003360 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3361 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3362 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003363 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3364 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3365 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3366 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003367
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003368 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3369 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3370 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3371 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3372 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003373
3374 Example:
3375 capture response header Content-length len 9
3376 capture response header Location len 15
3377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003378 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003379 about logging.
3380
3381
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003382compression algo <algorithm> ...
3383compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003384compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003385 Enable HTTP compression.
3386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3387 yes | yes | yes | yes
3388 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003389 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3390 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3391 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3392
3393 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003394 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3395 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3396 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003397
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003398 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003399 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003400
3401 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3402 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3403 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3404 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3405 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003406 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003407
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003408 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3409 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3410 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3411 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3412 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3413 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3414 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003415 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003416
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003417 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003418 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003419 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3420 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3421 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3422 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3423 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003424
3425 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3426 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3427 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3428 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3429 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003430 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3431 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3432 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3433 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3434 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003435 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3436 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003437
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003438 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003439 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3440 "Accept-Encoding" header
3441 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003442 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003443 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3444 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3445 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3446 "multipart"
3447 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3448 header
3449 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3450 and later
3451 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3452 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003453 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003454
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003455 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003456
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003457 Examples :
3458 compression algo gzip
3459 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003461
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003462cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003463 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3464 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003465 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3468 yes | no | yes | yes
3469 Arguments :
3470 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3471 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3472 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3473 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3474 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3475 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003476 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003477 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3478 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3479
3480 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3481 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3482 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3483 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3484 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3485 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003486 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3487 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003488 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003489 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3490 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491
3492 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003493 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003494
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003495 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003496 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003497 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003498 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003499 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3500 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3501 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3502 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3503 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3504 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3505 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003506
3507 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3508 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3509 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3510 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3511 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3512 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3513 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3514 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3515 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003516 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003517 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3518 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3519 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003520
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003521 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3522 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3523 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003524 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3525 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3526 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3527 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003528 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3529 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3530 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003531
3532 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3533 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3534 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3535 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3536 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3537 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3538 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3539 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3540 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3541
3542 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3543 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3544 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3545 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3546 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3547 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3548 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3549 persistence cookie in the cache.
3550 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3551
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003552 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3553 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3554 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3555 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3556 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003557 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003558 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3559 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3560 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3561 they logout.
3562
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003563 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3564 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3565 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3566 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3567
3568 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3569 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3570 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3571 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3572 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3573 this attribute.
3574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003575 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003576 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003577 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3578 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3579 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3580 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3581 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3582 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003583
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003584 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3585 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3586 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3587 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3588 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3589 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3590 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3591 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003592 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003593 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3594 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3595 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3596 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3597 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3598 the site.
3599
3600 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3601 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3602 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3603 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3604 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3605 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3606 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3607 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3608 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3609 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3610 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3611 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3612 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003613 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003614 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3615 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3616
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003617 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3618 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3619 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3620 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3621 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3622 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3623
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003624 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3625 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3626 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3627 repeated.
3628
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003629 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3630 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3631 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3632 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003634 Examples :
3635 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3636 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3637 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003638 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003639
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003640 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003641
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003642
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003643declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3644 Declares a capture slot.
3645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3646 no | yes | yes | no
3647 Arguments:
3648 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3649
3650 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3651 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3652 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3653 for use in the response.
3654
3655 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003656 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003657 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3658
3659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003660default-server [param*]
3661 Change default options for a server in a backend
3662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3663 yes | no | yes | yes
3664 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003665 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3666 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3667 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3668 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003669
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003670 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003671 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3672
3673 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003675
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003676default_backend <backend>
3677 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3679 yes | yes | yes | no
3680 Arguments :
3681 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3682
3683 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3684 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3685 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3686 will catch all undetermined requests.
3687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003688 Example :
3689
3690 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3691 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3692 default_backend dynamic
3693
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003694 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003696
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003697description <string>
3698 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3700 no | yes | yes | yes
3701 Arguments : string
3702
3703 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3704 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3705 it describes.
3706 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3707
3708
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003709disabled
3710 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3712 yes | yes | yes | yes
3713 Arguments : none
3714
3715 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3716 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3717 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3718 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3719 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3720 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3721 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3722
3723 See also : "enabled"
3724
3725
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003726dispatch <address>:<port>
3727 Set a default server address
3728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3729 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003730 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003731
3732 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3733 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3734 during start-up.
3735
3736 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3737 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3738 possible with normal servers.
3739
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003740 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003741 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3742 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3743 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3744 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3745
3746 See also : "server"
3747
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003748
3749dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3750 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3752 yes | no | yes | yes
3753 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3754
3755 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003756 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003757 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3758 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003759 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003760 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003762enabled
3763 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | yes | yes | yes
3766 Arguments : none
3767
3768 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3769 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3770
3771 See also : "disabled"
3772
3773
3774errorfile <code> <file>
3775 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3777 yes | yes | yes | yes
3778 Arguments :
3779 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003780 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3781 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003782
3783 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003784 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003785 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003786 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3787 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003788
3789 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3790 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3791 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3792
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003793 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3794
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003795 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3796 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3797 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3798 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3799
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003800 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3801 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003802 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003803 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3804 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3805 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003807 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3808 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3809 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003810 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003811 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3812
3813 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3814
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003815 Example :
3816 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003817 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003818 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3819 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3820
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003821
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003822errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3823 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3824 section.
3825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3826 yes | yes | yes | yes
3827 Arguments :
3828 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3829
3830 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3831 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3832 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3833
3834 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3835 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3836 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3837 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3838 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3839 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3840 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3841
3842 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3843 3.8 about http-errors.
3844
3845 Example :
3846 errorfiles generic
3847 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3848
3849
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003850errorloc <code> <url>
3851errorloc302 <code> <url>
3852 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3854 yes | yes | yes | yes
3855 Arguments :
3856 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003857 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3858 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003859
3860 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3861 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3862 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3863 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003864 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003865
3866 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3867 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3868 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3869
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003870 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3871
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003872 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3873 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3874 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3875 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003876 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003877 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3878 request.
3879
3880 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3881
3882
3883errorloc303 <code> <url>
3884 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3886 yes | yes | yes | yes
3887 Arguments :
3888 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003889 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3890 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003891
3892 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3893 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3894 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3895 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003896 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003897
3898 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3899 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3900 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3901
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003902 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3903
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003904 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3905 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3906 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3907 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003908 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003909
3910 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3911
3912
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003913email-alert from <emailaddr>
3914 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003915 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003916 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3917 yes | yes | yes | yes
3918
3919 Arguments :
3920
3921 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3922
3923 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3924 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3925
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003926 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003927 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3928 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003929
3930
3931email-alert level <level>
3932 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3933 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3935 yes | yes | yes | yes
3936
3937 Arguments :
3938
3939 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3940 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3941 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3942
3943 By default level is alert
3944
3945 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3946 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3947 for the proxy.
3948
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003949 Alerts are sent when :
3950
3951 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3952 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3953 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3954 is notice or lower
3955 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3956 and a health check status update occurs
3957
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003958 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3959 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003960 section 3.6 about mailers.
3961
3962
3963email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3964 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3966 yes | yes | yes | yes
3967
3968 Arguments :
3969
3970 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3971
3972 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3973 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3974
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003975 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3976 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003977
3978
3979email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3980 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3981 mailers.
3982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3983 yes | yes | yes | yes
3984
3985 Arguments :
3986
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003987 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003988
3989 By default the systems hostname is used.
3990
3991 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3992 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3993 for the proxy.
3994
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003995 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3996 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003997
3998
3999email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004000 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004001 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4002 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4003 yes | yes | yes | yes
4004
4005 Arguments :
4006
4007 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4008
4009 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4010 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4011
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004012 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004013 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4014
4015
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004016force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4017 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004019 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004020
4021 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4022 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4023 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4024 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4025 marked down for maintenance operations.
4026
4027 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4028 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4029 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4030 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4031 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4032 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4033 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4034 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4035 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4036
4037 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4038 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4039 is used.
4040
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004041 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004042 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004043
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004044
4045filter <name> [param*]
4046 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4048 no | yes | yes | yes
4049 Arguments :
4050 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4051 referenced in section 9.
4052
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004053 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004054 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004055 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4056 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004057
4058 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4059 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4060
4061 Example:
4062 listen
4063 bind *:80
4064
4065 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4066 filter compression
4067 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4068
4069 compression algo gzip
4070 compression offload
4071
4072 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4073
4074 See also : section 9.
4075
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004076
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004077fullconn <conns>
4078 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4080 yes | no | yes | yes
4081 Arguments :
4082 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4083 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4084
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004085 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004086 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004087 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004088 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4089 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4090 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4091 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4092 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004093 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004094
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004095 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4096 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004097 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4098 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4099 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004100
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004101 Example :
4102 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4103 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4104 # connections.
4105 backend dynamic
4106 fullconn 10000
4107 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4108 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4109
4110 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4111
4112
4113grace <time>
4114 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004116 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004117 Arguments :
4118 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4119 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4120 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4121
4122 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4123 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004124 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004125 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4126
4127 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4128 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4129 simplify it.
4130
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004131
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004132hash-balance-factor <factor>
4133 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4135 yes | no | no | yes
4136 Arguments :
4137 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4138 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004139 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004140
4141 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4142 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4143 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4144 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4145 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4146 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4147 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4148
4149 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4150 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4151 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4152 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4153 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4154
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004155 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4156 consistent hashing mechanism.
4157
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004158 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4159
4160
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004161hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004162 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4164 yes | no | yes | yes
4165 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004166 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4167 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004168
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004169 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4170 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4171 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4172 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4173 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4174 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4175 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4176 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4177 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4178 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004179
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004180 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4181 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4182 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4183 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4184 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4185 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4186 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4187 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4188 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4189 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4190 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4191 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4192 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004193 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4194 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004195
4196 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4197
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004198 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004199 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4200 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4201 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004202 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4203 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4204 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004205
4206 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4207 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004208 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4209 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4210 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4211 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4212
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004213 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4214 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4215 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4216 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4217 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4218 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4219 parameter.
4220
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004221 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4222 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4223 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4224 used on strings.
4225
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004226 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4227
4228 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4229 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4230 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4231 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4232 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4233 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4234 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4235 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4236 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4237 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4238 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4239 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004240
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004241 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4242 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4243 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004244
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004245 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004246
4247
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004248http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4249 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4250 ones).
4251
4252 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4253 no | yes | yes | yes
4254
4255 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4256 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4257 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4258 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4259 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4260 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4261
4262 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4263 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4264 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4265
4266 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4267 below.
4268
4269 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4270 instance.
4271
4272 Example:
4273 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4274 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4275 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4276
4277http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4278
4279 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4280 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4281 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4282 example, or to pass some internal information.
4283 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4284 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4285 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4286
4287http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4288
4289 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4290 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4291
4292http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4293
4294 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4295
4296http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4297 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4298
4299 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4300
4301 Example:
4302 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4303
4304 # applied to:
4305 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4306
4307 # outputs:
4308 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4309
4310 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4311
4312http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4313 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4314
4315 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4316
4317 Example:
4318 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4319
4320 # applied to:
4321 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4322
4323 # outputs:
4324 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4325
4326http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4327
4328 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4329 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4330 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4331
4332http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4333 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4334
4335 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4336 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4337 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4338 fallback.
4339
4340 Example:
4341 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4342 http-response set-status 431
4343 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4344 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4345
4346http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4347
4348 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4349 inline.
4350
4351 Arguments:
4352 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4353 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4354 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4355 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4356 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4357 (request and response)
4358 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4359 processing
4360 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4361 processing
4362 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4363 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4364 and '_'.
4365
4366 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4367 followed by some converters.
4368
4369 Example:
4370 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4371
4372http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4373
4374 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4375 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4376 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4377 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4378 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004379 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004380 processing.
4381
4382 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4383 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4384 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4385 rules evaluation.
4386
4387http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4388
4389 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4390 details about <var-name>.
4391
4392 Example:
4393 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4394
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004395
4396http-check comment <string>
4397 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4398 it fails.
4399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4400 yes | no | yes | yes
4401
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004402 Arguments :
4403 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4404 rule fails.
4405
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004406 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4407 user-friendly error reporting.
4408
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004409 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4410 "http-check expect".
4411
4412
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004413http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4414 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004415 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004416 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4418 yes | no | yes | yes
4419
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004420 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004421 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4422
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004423 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4424 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4425
4426 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4427 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4428 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4429 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4430
4431 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4432
4433 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4434
4435 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4436
4437 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4438
4439 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4440
4441 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4442 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4443 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4444 is used.
4445
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004446 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4447 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4448 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4449 haproxy -vv.
4450
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004451 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4452
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004453 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4454 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4455 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4456 different ports or with different servers.
4457
4458 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4459 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4460 the port with a "http-check connect".
4461
4462 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4463 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4464 do.
4465
4466 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4467 unset-var or comment rules.
4468
4469 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004470 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4471 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4472 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4473 option httpchk
4474
4475 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004476 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004477 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004478 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004479 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004480 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004481
4482 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4483
4484 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004485
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004486
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004487http-check disable-on-404
4488 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004490 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004491 Arguments : none
4492
4493 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4494 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4495 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4496 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4497 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4498 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4499 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4500 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004501 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4502 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4503 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4504
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004505 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004506
4507
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004508http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004509 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4510 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4511 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004512 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004514 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004515
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004516 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004517 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4518
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004519 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4520 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4521 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4522 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4523 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4524 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4525 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4526 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4527 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4528 result is always conclusive.
4529
4530 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4531 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4532 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004533 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4534 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4535 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4536 example 404 with disable-on-404
4537 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4538 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4539 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004540
4541 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4542 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004543 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4544 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4545 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4546 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4547 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4548 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004549
4550 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4551 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004552 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4553 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4554 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4555 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004556 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4557
4558 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4559 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4560 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4561 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4562
4563 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4564 informational message reported in logs if an error
4565 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4566 log-format string.
4567
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004568 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004569 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4570 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004571 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4572 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4573 details on the supported keywords.
4574
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004575 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4576 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4577 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4578 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004579
4580 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4581 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4582 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4583 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4584 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4585
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004586 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4587 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4588 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4589 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4590 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4591 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4592 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004593
4594 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004595 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004596 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4597 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4598 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4599 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4600
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004601 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4602 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004603 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4604 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4605 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4606 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4607 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4608 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4609 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4610 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004611 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4612 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4613 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4614 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4615 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4616 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4617 insensitive on the header names.
4618
4619 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4620 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4621 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4622 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4623 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4624 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004625
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004626 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004627 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004628 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4629 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4630 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4631 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4632 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004633 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004634 trace).
4635
4636 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004637 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004638 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4639 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4640 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4641 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4642 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004643 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004644
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004645 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4646 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4647 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4648 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4649 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4650 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4651
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004652 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4653 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4654 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4655 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4656 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4657 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4658 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4659 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4660
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004661 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4662 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4663 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4664 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4665 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004666
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004667 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4668 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4669
4670 Examples :
4671 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004672 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004673
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004674 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4675 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4676
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004677 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004678 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004679
4680 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004681 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004682
4683 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004684 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004685
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004686 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004687 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004688
4689
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004690http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004691 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
4692 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004693 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4694 health checks.
4695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4696 yes | no | yes | yes
4697 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004698 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4699
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004700 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4701 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4702 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4703 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4704 to invent non-standard ones.
4705
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004706 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4707 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
4708 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
4709 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4710
4711 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4712 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
4713 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4714 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004715
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004716 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004717 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4718 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4719 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4720 to add it.
4721
4722 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4723 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4724 to the log-format rules.
4725
4726 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4727 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4728 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004729
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004730 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
4731 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4732 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
4733 request.
4734
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004735 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4736 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4737 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004738 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4739 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4740 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4741 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004742 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4743 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4744 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4745
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004746 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4747 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004748 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4749 so, it will be ignored.
4750
4751 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4752 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4753 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4754 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4755 configured request authority.
4756
4757 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4758 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004759
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004760 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004761
4762
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004763http-check send-state
4764 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4766 yes | no | yes | yes
4767 Arguments : none
4768
4769 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4770 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4771 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4772 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4773 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4774
4775 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4776 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4777 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4778 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4779 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004780 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4781 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4782 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4783
4784 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4785 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4786 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4787
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004788 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4789 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4790 checked in multiple backends.
4791
4792 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4793 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4794
4795 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4796 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4797 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4798 one fails.
4799
4800 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4801 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4802 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4803
4804 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4805 server's queue.
4806
4807 Example of a header received by the application server :
4808 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4809 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4810
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004811 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4812 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004813
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004814
4815http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004816 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4818 yes | no | yes | yes
4819
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004820 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004821 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4822 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4823 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4824 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4825 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4826 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4827 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4828 and '-'.
4829
4830 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4831
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004832 Examples :
4833 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004834
4835
4836http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004837 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4839 yes | no | yes | yes
4840
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004841 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004842 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4843 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4844 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4845 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4846 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4847 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4848 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4849 and '-'.
4850
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004851 Examples :
4852 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004854
4855http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004856 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4857
4858 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4859 no | yes | yes | yes
4860
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004861 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4862 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4863 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4864 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4865 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004866
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004867 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4868 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004870 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004872 Example:
4873 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4874 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4875 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004876
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004877 http-request allow if nagios
4878 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4879 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4880 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004881
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004882 Example:
4883 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4884 acl add path /addacl
4885 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004887 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004889 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4890 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004891
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004892 Example:
4893 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4894 acl setmap path /setmap
4895 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004896
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004897 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004899 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4900 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004902 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4903 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004904
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004905http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004906
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004907 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4908 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4909 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4910 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4911 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4912 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4913 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4914 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004916http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004917
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004918 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4919 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4920 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4921 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4922 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4923 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4924 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4925 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004926
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004927http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004928
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004929 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4930 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004931
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004932
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004933http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004934
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004935 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4936 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4937 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4938 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4939 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004940
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004941 Example:
4942 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4943 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004944
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004945http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004946
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004947 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004948
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004949http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4950 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004952 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4953 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4954 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4955 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4956 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4957 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4958 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4959 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4960 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004962 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4963 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4964 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004965 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4966
4967 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4968 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4969 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4970 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004971
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004972http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004973
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004974 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4975 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4976 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4977 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4978 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4979 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004980
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004981http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004983 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004984
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004985http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004986
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004987 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4988 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4989 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4990 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4991 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4992 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004993
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02004994http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4995http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
4996 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4997 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
4998 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
4999 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005000
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005001 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5002 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5003 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
5004 return" for details. For compatiblity purpose, when no argument is defined,
5005 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5006 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5007 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005008 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005009 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005010
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005011http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5012 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5013 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5014 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5015
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005016http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5017
5018 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5019 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5020 pointed by <resolvers>.
5021 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5022 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5023 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5024 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5025 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5026 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5027 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5028 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5029 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5030 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5031 to 0.0.0.0.
5032
5033 Example:
5034 resolvers mydns
5035 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5036 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5037 timeout retry 1s
5038 hold valid 10s
5039 hold nx 3s
5040 hold other 3s
5041 hold obsolete 0s
5042 accepted_payload_size 8192
5043
5044 frontend fe
5045 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5046 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5047 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5048
5049 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5050 # which mean DNS resolution error
5051 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5052
5053 default_backend be
5054
5055 backend b_503
5056 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5057 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5058 # 503 error page to end users
5059
5060 backend be
5061 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5062 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5063 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5064 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5065 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5066
5067 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5068 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5069
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005070http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5071
5072 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5073 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5074 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5075 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005076 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5077 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005078
5079 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005081http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005083 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5084 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5085 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5086 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5087 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005089http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005091 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5092 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5093 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5094 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005096http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5097 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005098
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005099 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005100 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5101 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5102 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5103 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5104 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005105
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005106 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5107 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5108 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5109 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5110 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005111
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005112 Example:
5113 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5114
5115 # applied to:
5116 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5117
5118 # outputs:
5119 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5120
5121 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005122
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005123 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5124
5125 # applied to:
5126 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005127
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005128 # outputs:
5129 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005130
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005131http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5132 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5133
5134 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5135 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5136 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5137 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5138
5139 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5140 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5141 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5142
5143 Example:
5144 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5145 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5146
5147 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5148 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5149
5150 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5151 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5152 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5153 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5154
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005155http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5156 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5157
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005158 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5159 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5160 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5161 against.
5162
5163 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5164 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5165 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005166
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005167 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5168 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5169 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5170 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5171 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5172 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5173 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5174 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5175 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005176 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5177 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005178
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005179 Example:
5180 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5181 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005182
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005183 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5184 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005185
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005186http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5187 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005188
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005189 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5190 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5191 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5192 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005193
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005194 Example:
5195 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005196
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005197 # applied to:
5198 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005199
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005200 # outputs:
5201 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005202
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005203http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5204 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5205 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005206 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005207 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5208
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005209 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005210 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5211 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5212 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5213 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005214 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005215 are followed to create the response :
5216
5217 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5218 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5219 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5220 ignored.
5221
5222 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5223 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5224 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5225 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5226 ignored.
5227
5228 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5229 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5230 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5231 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5232 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5233
5234 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5235 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5236 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5237 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5238 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5239 if any, is ignored.
5240
5241 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5242 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5243 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5244 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5245 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5246 as a raw content.
5247
5248 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5249 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5250 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5251 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5252 considered as a raw string.
5253
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005254 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5255 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5256 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5257 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5258
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005259 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5260 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5261 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5262
5263 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5264
5265 Example:
5266 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5267 if { path /ping }
5268
5269 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5270 if { path /favicon.ico }
5271
5272 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5273 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5274 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005276http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5277http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005279 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5280 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5281 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005282
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005283http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5284 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005285
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005286 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5287 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5288 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5289 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005291http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005293 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5294 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5295 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5296 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5297 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005299 Arguments:
5300 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5301 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005302
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005303 Example:
5304 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5305 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005307 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5308 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005310http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005312 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5313 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5314 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005316 Arguments:
5317 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5318 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005320 Example:
5321 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5322 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005324 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5325 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5326 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005328http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005330 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5331 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5332 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5333 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5334 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005336 Example:
5337 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5338 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5339 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5340 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5341 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5342 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5343 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5344 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5345 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005347http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005349 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5350 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5351 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5352 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5353 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005355http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5356 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005358 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5359 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5360 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5361 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5362 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5363 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5364 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5365 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5366 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005368http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005370 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5371 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5372 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5373 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5374 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5375 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5376 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005378http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005380 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5381 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5382 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005384http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005386 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5387 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5388 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5389 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5390 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5391 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5392 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5393 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005395http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005397 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5398 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5399 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5400 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5401 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5402 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005404 Example :
5405 # prepend the host name before the path
5406 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005408http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005410 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5411 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5412 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5413 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5414 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005416http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005418 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5419 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5420 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5421 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5422 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5423 values have higher priority.
5424 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5425 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5426 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5427 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5428 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005430http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005432 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5433 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5434 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5435 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5436 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5437 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5438 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005440 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005441
5442 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005443 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5444 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005446http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5447 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5448 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5449 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005450 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5451 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005452
5453 Arguments :
5454 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5455 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005456
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005457 See also "option forwardfor".
5458
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005459 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005460 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5461 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5462
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005463 # After the masking this will track connections
5464 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5465 http-request track-sc0 src
5466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005467 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5468 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5469
5470http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5471
5472 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5473 expression.
5474
5475 Arguments:
5476 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5477 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005478
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005479 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005480 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5481 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5482
5483 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5484 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5485 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5486
5487http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5488
5489 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5490 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5491 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5492 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5493 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5494 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5495 information from the request.
5496
5497 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5498
5499http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5500
5501 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5502 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5503 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5504 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5505 path and the query string.
5506 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5507
5508http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5509
5510 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5511 inline.
5512
5513 Arguments:
5514 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5515 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5516 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5517 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5518 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5519 (request and response)
5520 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5521 processing
5522 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5523 processing
5524 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5525 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5526 and '_'.
5527
5528 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5529 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005530
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005531 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005532 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005534http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5535 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005537 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5538 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5539 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5540 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5541 agent name must be used.
5542
5543 Arguments:
5544 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5545
5546 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5547 configuration.
5548
5549http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5550
5551 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5552 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5553 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5554 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5555 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5556 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5557 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5558 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5559 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5560 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5561 action.
5562 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5563 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5564 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5565 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5566 you fully understand how it works.
5567
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005568http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5569
5570 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5571 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5572 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5573 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5574 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005575 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005576 processing.
5577
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005578 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005579 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5580 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5581 rules evaluation.
5582
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005583http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5584http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5585 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5586 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5587 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5588 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005589
5590 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5591 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5592 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005593 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
5594 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
5595 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
5596 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
5597 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
5598 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
5599 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
5600 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
5601 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
5602 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
5603 For compatiblity purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
5604 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5605 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5606 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
5607 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5608 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005609
5610http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5611http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5612http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5613
5614 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5615 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5616 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5617 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5618 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5619 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5620 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5621 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5622 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5623 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5624 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5625 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5626
5627 Arguments :
5628 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5629 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5630 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5631 select which table entry to update the counters.
5632
5633 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5634 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5635 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5636 that table until the session ends.
5637
5638 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5639 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5640 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5641 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5642 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5643 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5644 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5645 useful information.
5646
5647 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5648 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5649 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5650 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5651 checks that make use of it.
5652
5653http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5654
5655 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005656
5657 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005658 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005659
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005660http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5661
5662 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5663 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5664 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5665 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5666 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5667 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5668
5669 Arguments :
5670 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5671
5672 Example:
5673 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005675http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005677 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5678 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5679 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005680
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005681
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005682http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005683 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5684
5685 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5686 no | yes | yes | yes
5687
5688 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5689 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5690 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5691 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5692 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5693 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5694
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005695 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5696 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005697
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005698 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005699
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005700 Example:
5701 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005702
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005703 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005704
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005705 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5706 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005707
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005708 Example:
5709 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005710
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005711 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005712
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005713 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5714 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005715
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005716 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5717 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005718
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005719http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005720
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005721 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5722 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5723 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5724 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5725 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5726 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5727 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5728 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005730http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005731
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005732 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5733 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5734 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5735 example, or to pass some internal information.
5736 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5737 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5738 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005739
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005740http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005741
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005742 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5743 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005744
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005745http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005746
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005747 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005748
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005749http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005750
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005751 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5752 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5753 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5754 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5755 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5756 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5757 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005759 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5760 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5761 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5762 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5763 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005764
5765 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5766 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5767 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5768 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005769
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005770http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005771
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005772 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5773 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5774 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5775 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5776 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5777 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005778
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005779http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005780
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005781 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005782
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005783http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005785 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5786 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5787 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5788 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5789 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5790 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005791
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005792http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5793http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5794 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5795 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5796 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5797 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005798
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005799 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
5800 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5801 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
5802 "http-response return" for details. For compatiblity purpose, when no
5803 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
5804 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
5805 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005806 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005807 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005808
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005809http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005810
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005811 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5812 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5813 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5814 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5815 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5816 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005817
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005818http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5819 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005820
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005821 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5822 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005823
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005824 Example:
5825 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005827 # applied to:
5828 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005830 # outputs:
5831 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005832
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005833 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005834
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005835http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5836 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005837
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005838 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005839 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005841 Example:
5842 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005843
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005844 # applied to:
5845 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005846
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005847 # outputs:
5848 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005849
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005850http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5851 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5852 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005853 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005854 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5855
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005856 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005857 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5858 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5859 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5860 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005861 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005862 are followed to create the response :
5863
5864 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5865 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5866 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5867 ignored.
5868
5869 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5870 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5871 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5872 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5873 ignored.
5874
5875 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5876 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5877 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5878 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5879 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5880
5881 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5882 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5883 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5884 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5885 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5886 if any, is ignored.
5887
5888 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5889 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5890 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5891 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5892 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5893 as a raw content.
5894
5895 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5896 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5897 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5898 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5899 considered as a raw string.
5900
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005901 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5902 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5903 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5904 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5905
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005906 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5907 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5908 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5909
5910 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5911
5912 Example:
5913 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5914 if { status eq 404 }
5915
5916 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5917 string "This is the end !" \
5918 if { status eq 500 }
5919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005920http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5921http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005922
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005923 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5924 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5925 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005926
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005927http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5928 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005929
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005930 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5931 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5932 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5933 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005934
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005935http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005937 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5938 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5939 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5940 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5941 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005942
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005943 Arguments:
5944 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005946 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5947 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005949http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005950
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005951 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5952 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5953 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005954
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005955http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5956
5957 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5958 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5959 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5960 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5961 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5962
5963http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5964
5965 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5966 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5967 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5968 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5969 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5970 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5971 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5972 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5973 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5974
5975http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5976
5977 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5978 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5979 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5980 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5981 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5982 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5983 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5984
5985http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5986
5987 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5988 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5989 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5990 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5991 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5992 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5993 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5994 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5995
5996http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5997 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5998
5999 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6000 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6001 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6002 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006003
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006004 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006005 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6006 http-response set-status 431
6007 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6008 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006010http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006011
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006012 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6013 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6014 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6015 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6016 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6017 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6018 based on some information from the request.
6019
6020 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6021
6022http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6023
6024 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6025 inline.
6026
6027 Arguments:
6028 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6029 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6030 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6031 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6032 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6033 (request and response)
6034 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6035 processing
6036 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6037 processing
6038 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6039 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6040 and '_'.
6041
6042 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6043 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006044
6045 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006046 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006048http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006050 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6051 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6052 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6053 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6054 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6055 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6056 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6057 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6058 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6059 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6060 action.
6061 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6062 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6063 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6064 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6065 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006066
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006067http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6068
6069 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6070 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6071 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6072 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6073 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006074 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006075 processing.
6076
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006077 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006078 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6079 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
6080 rules evaluation.
6081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006082http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6083http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6084http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006086 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6087 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6088 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6089 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6090 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6091 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6092
6093http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6094
6095 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6096 about <var-name>.
6097
6098 Example:
6099 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6100
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006101
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006102http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6103 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6104
6105 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6106 yes | no | yes | yes
6107
6108 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006109 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6110 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6111 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006112
6113 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6114
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006115 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6116 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6117 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6118 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6119 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6120 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6121 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6122 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6123 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6124 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006125
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006126 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6127 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6128 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6129 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6130 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6131 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6132 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6133 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006134
6135 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6136 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6137 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6138 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6139 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6140 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6141 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6142 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006143 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006144 downsides of rare connection failures.
6145
6146 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6147 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6148 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6149 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6150 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6151 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006152 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006153 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6154 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6155 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6156 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6157 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6158
6159 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006160 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6161 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6162 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006163
6164 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006165 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006166
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006167 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6168 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006169
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006170 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006171
6172 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6173 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6174 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6175
6176 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6177
6178
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006179http-send-name-header [<header>]
6180 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006181 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6182 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006183 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006184 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6185
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006186 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6187 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6188 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6189 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6190 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6191 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6192 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6193 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6194 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6195 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6196 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6197 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6198 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6199 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6200 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6201 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006202
6203 See also : "server"
6204
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006205id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006206 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6208 no | yes | yes | yes
6209 Arguments : none
6210
6211 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6212 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6213 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006214
6215
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006216ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6217 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006219 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006220
6221 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6222 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6223 and running).
6224
6225 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6226 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6227 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006228 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006229 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6230
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006231 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6232 "unless" condition is met.
6233
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006234 Example:
6235 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6236 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6237 ignore-persist if url_static
6238
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006239 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6240
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006241load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6242 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6244 yes | no | yes | yes
6245
6246 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6247 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6248 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006249 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006250 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6251 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6252 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6253 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6254
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006255 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006256 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006257 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006258
6259 Arguments:
6260 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6261 named "server-state-file".
6262
6263 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6264 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6265 name is used as a file name.
6266
6267 none don't load any stat for this backend
6268
6269 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006270 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6271 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6272 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006273 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006274 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006275
6276 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6277 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6278
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006279 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006280
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006281 global
6282 stats socket /tmp/socket
6283 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006284
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006285 defaults
6286 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006287
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006288 backend bk
6289 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6290 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006291
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006292
6293 Then one can run :
6294
6295 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6296
6297 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6298
6299 1
6300 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6301 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6302 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6303
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006304 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006305
6306 global
6307 stats socket /tmp/socket
6308 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6309
6310 defaults
6311 load-server-state-from-file local
6312
6313 backend bk
6314 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6315 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6316
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006317
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006318 Then one can run :
6319
6320 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6321
6322 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6323
6324 1
6325 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6326 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6327 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6328
6329 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6330 "show servers state"
6331
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006332
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006333log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006334log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6335 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006336no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006337 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6339 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006340
6341 Prefix :
6342 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6343 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6344 prefix does not allow arguments.
6345
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006346 Arguments :
6347 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6348 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6349 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6350 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6351 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6352 parameter.
6353
6354 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6355 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6356
6357 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6358 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6359 standard syslog port).
6360
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006361 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6362 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6363 standard syslog port).
6364
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006365 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6366 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6367 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006368 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006369
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006370 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6371 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6372 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6373 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6374 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6375 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6376 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6377 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6378 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6379 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6380 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6381 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6382 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6383 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6384 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6385 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006386 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6387 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006388
6389 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6390 and "fd@2", see above.
6391
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006392 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6393 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6394 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6395 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6396 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6397 having the logs instantly available.
6398
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006399 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6400 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006401
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006402 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6403 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6404 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6405 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6406 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6407 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6408 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6409 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6410 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6411 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006412 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006413
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006414 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6415 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6416 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6417 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6418 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6419
6420 <sample_size>
6421 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6422 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6423 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6424 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6425 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6426
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006427 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6428 one of the following :
6429
6430 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6431 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6432
6433 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6434 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6435
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006436 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6437 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6438 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6439 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6440 systemd logger consumes.
6441
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006442 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6443 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6444 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6445 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6446
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006447 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6448
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006449 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6450 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6451 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6452
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006453 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6454 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6455 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6456 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006457
6458 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6459 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6460 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006461 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6462 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6463 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6464 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6465 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006466
6467 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6468
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006469 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6470 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6471 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006472
6473 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6474 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6475 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6476 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6477
6478 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6479 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006480
6481 Example :
6482 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006483 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6484 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6485 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006486 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6487 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006488 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006489
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006490
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006491log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006492 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6494 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006495
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006496 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6497 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6498 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6499 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6500 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006501
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006502 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6503 "option httplog" directives.
6504
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006505log-format-sd <string>
6506 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6507 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6508 yes | yes | yes | no
6509
6510 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6511 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6512 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6513 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6514 which covers the log format string in depth.
6515
6516 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6517 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6518
6519 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6520 log format to "rfc5424".
6521
6522 Example :
6523 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6524
6525
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006526log-tag <string>
6527 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6528 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6529 yes | yes | yes | yes
6530
6531 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6532 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6533 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6534 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6535 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6536 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6537 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6538 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6539 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006540
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006541max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6542 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6543 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6544 yes | no | yes | yes
6545
6546 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6547 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6548 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6549 servers.
6550
6551 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6552 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6553 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6554 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6555 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006556 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006557 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6558 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6559 picking a different server.
6560
6561 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6562 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6563 even if they have to be queued.
6564
6565 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6566 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6567
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006568max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6569 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6570 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6571 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006572
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006573maxconn <conns>
6574 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6576 yes | yes | yes | no
6577 Arguments :
6578 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6579 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6580 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6581 closes.
6582
6583 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6584 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6585 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6586 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006587 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6588 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6589 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6590 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006591
6592 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6593 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6594 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6595
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006596 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6597 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006598
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006599 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6600
6601
6602mode { tcp|http|health }
6603 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6605 yes | yes | yes | yes
6606 Arguments :
6607 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6608 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6609 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6610 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6611
6612 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6613 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6614 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6615 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6616 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6617
6618 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006619 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6620 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6621 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6622 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6623 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6624 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6625 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006626
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006627 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6628 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6629 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006630
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006631 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006632 defaults http_instances
6633 mode http
6634
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006635 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006636
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006637
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006638monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006639 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6641 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006642 Arguments :
6643 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6644 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006645 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006646 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6647 backend and its backup.
6648
6649 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6650 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6651 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6652 servers in a list of backends.
6653
6654 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6655 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6656 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6657 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6658 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6659 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6660 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006661 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6662 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006663
6664 Example:
6665 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006666 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006667 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6668 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6669 monitor-uri /site_alive
6670 monitor fail if site_dead
6671
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006672 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006673
6674
6675monitor-net <source>
6676 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6678 yes | yes | yes | no
6679 Arguments :
6680 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6681 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6682 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6683 followed by a mask.
6684
6685 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6686 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006687 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006688 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6689
6690 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6691 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6692 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6693 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006694 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6695 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6696 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006697
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006698 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6699 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6700 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6701 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6702 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6703 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006704
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006705 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6706 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006708 Example :
6709 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6710 frontend www
6711 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6712
6713 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6714
6715
6716monitor-uri <uri>
6717 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6719 yes | yes | yes | no
6720 Arguments :
6721 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6722 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6723
6724 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6725 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6726 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6727 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6728 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6729 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6730 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6731 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6732
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006733 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006734 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6735 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6736 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6737 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6738 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6739 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006740
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006741 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6742 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6743 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6744 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6745
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006746 Example :
6747 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6748 frontend www
6749 mode http
6750 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6751
6752 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006754
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006755option abortonclose
6756no option abortonclose
6757 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6759 yes | no | yes | yes
6760 Arguments : none
6761
6762 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6763 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6764 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6765 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006766 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006767 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6768 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6769 encountered while delivering the response.
6770
6771 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6772 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6773 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6774 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6775 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6776 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006777 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006778 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006779 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006780 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6781 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6782 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6783
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006784 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6785 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006786 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6787 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6788 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6789 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6790 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6791 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006792 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006793
6794 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6795 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6796
6797 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6798
6799
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006800option accept-invalid-http-request
6801no option accept-invalid-http-request
6802 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6804 yes | yes | yes | no
6805 Arguments : none
6806
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006807 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006808 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006809 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006810 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6811 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6812 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6813 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6814 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006815 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6816 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6817 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6818 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006819 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006820 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006821 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6822 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6823 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006824
6825 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6826 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6827 been confirmed.
6828
6829 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6830 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006831 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6832 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006833 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6834
6835 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6836 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6837
6838 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6839 stats socket.
6840
6841
6842option accept-invalid-http-response
6843no option accept-invalid-http-response
6844 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6846 yes | no | yes | yes
6847 Arguments : none
6848
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006849 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006850 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006851 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006852 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6853 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6854 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6855 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6856 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006857 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6858 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6859 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006860
6861 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6862 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6863 been confirmed.
6864
6865 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6866 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6867 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6868 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6869
6870 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6871 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6872
6873 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6874 stats socket.
6875
6876
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006877option allbackups
6878no option allbackups
6879 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6881 yes | no | yes | yes
6882 Arguments : none
6883
6884 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6885 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6886 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6887 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6888 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6889 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6890 order between the backup servers anymore.
6891
6892 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6893 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6894
6895 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6896 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6897
6898
6899option checkcache
6900no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006901 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6903 yes | no | yes | yes
6904 Arguments : none
6905
6906 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6907 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006908 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006909 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6910 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006911 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006912
6913 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006914 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006915 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006916 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6917 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006918 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006919 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006920 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6921 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006922 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006923 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6924 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006925 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006926 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6927 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6928 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6929 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6930 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6931 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6932 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6933 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6934 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6935
6936 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006937 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6938 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6939 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6940 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006941
6942 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6943 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006944 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006945 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006946
6947 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6948 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6949
6950
6951option clitcpka
6952no option clitcpka
6953 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6955 yes | yes | yes | no
6956 Arguments : none
6957
6958 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6959 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006960 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006961 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6962
6963 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6964 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6965 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6966 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6967
6968 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6969 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6970 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6971 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6972 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6973
6974 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6975
6976 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6977 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6978 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6979
6980 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6981 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6982
6983 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6984
6985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006986option contstats
6987 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6989 yes | yes | yes | no
6990 Arguments : none
6991
6992 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6993 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6994 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6995 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006996 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6997 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6998 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6999 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7000 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007001
7002
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007003option dontlog-normal
7004no option dontlog-normal
7005 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7007 yes | yes | yes | no
7008 Arguments : none
7009
7010 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7011 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7012 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7013 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7014 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7015 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7016 logged.
7017
7018 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7019 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7020 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007022 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007023 logging.
7024
7025
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007026option dontlognull
7027no option dontlognull
7028 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7030 yes | yes | yes | no
7031 Arguments : none
7032
7033 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7034 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7035 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7036 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7037 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7038 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007039 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7040 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7041 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007042
7043 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007044 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007045 would not be logged.
7046
7047 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7048 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7049
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007050 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7051 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007052
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007053
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007054option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007055 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7057 yes | yes | yes | yes
7058 Arguments :
7059 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7060 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007061 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007062 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007063
7064 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7065 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7066 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7067 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7068 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7069 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7070 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007071 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7072 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7073 possible that the client has already brought one.
7074
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007075 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007076 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007077 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007078 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007079 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007080 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007081
7082 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7083 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7084 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7085 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7086 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7087 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7088 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7089
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007090 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7091 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7092 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7093 are under the control of the end-user.
7094
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007095 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007096 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7097 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007098 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7099 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7100 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007101
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007102 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007103 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7104 frontend www
7105 mode http
7106 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7107
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007108 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7109 backend www
7110 mode http
7111 option forwardfor header X-Client
7112
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007113 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007114 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007115
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007116
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007117option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7118no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7119 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7121 yes | yes | yes | no
7122 Arguments : none
7123
7124 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7125 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7126 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7127 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7128 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7129 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7130 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7131
7132 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7133 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7134 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7135 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7136 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7137 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7138 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7139 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7140 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7141 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7142
7143 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7144
7145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7147
7148 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7149 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7150
7151
7152option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7153no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7154 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7156 yes | no | yes | yes
7157 Arguments : none
7158
7159 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7160 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7161 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7162 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7163 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7164 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7165 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7166
7167 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7168 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7169 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7170 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7171 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7172 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7173 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7174 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7175 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7176 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7177
7178 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7179
7180 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7181 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7182
7183 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7184 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7185
7186
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007187option http-buffer-request
7188no option http-buffer-request
7189 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7191 yes | yes | yes | yes
7192 Arguments : none
7193
7194 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7195 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7196 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7197 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7198 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7199 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007200 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7201 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7202 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7203 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007204
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007205 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007206
7207
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007208option http-ignore-probes
7209no option http-ignore-probes
7210 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7212 yes | yes | yes | no
7213 Arguments : none
7214
7215 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7216 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7217 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7218 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7219 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7220 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7221 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7222 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7223 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007224 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7225 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007226 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7227
7228 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7229 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7230 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7231 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7232 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7233 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7234 are often the only way to detect them.
7235
7236 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7237 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7238
7239 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7240
7241
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007242option http-keep-alive
7243no option http-keep-alive
7244 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7246 yes | yes | yes | yes
7247 Arguments : none
7248
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007249 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7250 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007251 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7252 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007253 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7254 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7255 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007256
7257 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7258 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007259 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7260 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7261 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7262 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7263 situations where this option may be useful :
7264
7265 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007266 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007267
7268 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7269 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7270
7271 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7272 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7273 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7274 request.
7275
7276 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7277 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007278 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7279 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7280 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007281
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007282 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7283 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7284 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7285 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7286 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7287 not set.
7288
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007289 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7290 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7291 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007292
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007293 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007294 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007295 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007296
7297
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007298option http-no-delay
7299no option http-no-delay
7300 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7302 yes | yes | yes | yes
7303 Arguments : none
7304
7305 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7306 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7307 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7308 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7309 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7310 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7311 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7312 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7313 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7314 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7315 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7316 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7317 affected.
7318
7319 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7320 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7321 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7322 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7323 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7324 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7325 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7326 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7327 latency environments.
7328
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007329 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7330
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007331
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007332option http-pretend-keepalive
7333no option http-pretend-keepalive
7334 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007336 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007337 Arguments : none
7338
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007339 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007340 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7341 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7342 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7343 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7344 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7345 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7346 consider the response complete.
7347
7348 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7349 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7350 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7351 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007352 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007353 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7354
7355 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7356 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7357 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7358 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7359 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7360 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7361 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7362
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007363 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7364 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7365 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7366 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7367 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7368 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007369
7370 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7371 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7372
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007373 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007374 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007375
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007376
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007377option http-server-close
7378no option http-server-close
7379 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7381 yes | yes | yes | yes
7382 Arguments : none
7383
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007384 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7385 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7386 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7387 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007388 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7389 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7390 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7391 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7392 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7393 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7394 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7395 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7396 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7397 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7398 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007399
7400 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7401 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7402 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7403 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007404 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7405 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007406
7407 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7408 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007409 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7410 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7411 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007412
7413 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7414 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7415
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007416 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7417 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007418
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007419option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007420no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007421 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7423 yes | yes | yes | no
7424 Arguments : none
7425
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007426 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007427 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7428 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7429 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7430 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7431 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7432 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7433
7434 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7435 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007436 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7437 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7438 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007439
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007440 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7441 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7442 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7443 front of an existing proxy.
7444
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007445 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7446
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007447 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007448
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007449option httpchk
7450option httpchk <uri>
7451option httpchk <method> <uri>
7452option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007453 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7455 yes | no | yes | yes
7456 Arguments :
7457 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7458 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7459 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7460 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7461 ones.
7462
7463 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7464 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7465 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7466
7467 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7468 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7469 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007470 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007471
7472 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7473 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7474 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7475 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7476 the lack of any response.
7477
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007478 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7479 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7480 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7481 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7482
7483 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7484 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7485 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007486
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007487 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7488 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007489 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7490 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7491 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007492
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007493 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7494 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7495 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7496 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7497
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007498 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007499 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7500 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7501 backend https_relay
7502 mode tcp
7503 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7504 http-check send hdr Host www
7505 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007506
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007507 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7508 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7509 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007510
7511
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007512option httpclose
7513no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007514 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7516 yes | yes | yes | yes
7517 Arguments : none
7518
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007519 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7520 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7521 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7522 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007523 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007524
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007525 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7526 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007527 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007528 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7529 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007530
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007531 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7532 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7533 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007534
7535 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7536 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007537 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7538 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7539 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007540
7541 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7542 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7543
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007544 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007545
7546
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007547option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007548 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007550 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007551 Arguments :
7552 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7553 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7554 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007555 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007556 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007557
7558 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7559 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7560 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7561 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7562 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7563 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7564 ports.
7565
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007566 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7567 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007568
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007569 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007571 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007572
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007573
7574option http_proxy
7575no option http_proxy
7576 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7578 yes | yes | yes | yes
7579 Arguments : none
7580
7581 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7582 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7583 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7584 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7585 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7586
7587 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7588 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007589 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7590 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007591
7592 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7593 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7594
7595 Example :
7596 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7597 backend direct_forward
7598 option httpclose
7599 option http_proxy
7600
7601 See also : "option httpclose"
7602
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007603
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007604option independent-streams
7605no option independent-streams
7606 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7608 yes | yes | yes | yes
7609 Arguments : none
7610
7611 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7612 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7613 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7614 receive data or not.
7615
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007616 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007617 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7618 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7619 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7620 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7621 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7622 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7623 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7624 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7625 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7626 socket buffers.
7627
7628 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7629 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7630 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7631 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7632 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7633
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007634 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007635
7636
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007637option ldap-check
7638 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7640 yes | no | yes | yes
7641 Arguments : none
7642
7643 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7644 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7645 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7646 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7647
7648 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7649 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7650
7651 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7652 configure it.
7653
7654 Example :
7655 option ldap-check
7656
7657 See also : "option httpchk"
7658
7659
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007660option external-check
7661 Use external processes for server health checks
7662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7663 yes | no | yes | yes
7664
7665 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7666 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7667 command".
7668
7669 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7670
7671 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7672
7673
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007674option log-health-checks
7675no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007676 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7678 yes | no | yes | yes
7679 Arguments : none
7680
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007681 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7682 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7683 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007684
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007685 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7686 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7687 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7688 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7689 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7690
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007691 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007692 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007693
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007694 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7695 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7696 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007697
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007698
7699option log-separate-errors
7700no option log-separate-errors
7701 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7703 yes | yes | yes | no
7704 Arguments : none
7705
7706 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7707 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7708 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7709 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7710 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7711 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7712 provides very important information.
7713
7714 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7715 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7716 error logs.
7717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007718 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007719 logging.
7720
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007721
7722option logasap
7723no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007724 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7726 yes | yes | yes | no
7727 Arguments : none
7728
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007729 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7730 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7731 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7732 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7733
7734 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7735 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7736 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7737 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7738 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007739 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007740 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7741 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7742 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7743 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007744 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007745
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007746 Examples :
7747 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7748 mode http
7749 option httplog
7750 option logasap
7751 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7752
7753 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7754 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7755 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7756 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007758 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007759 logging.
7760
7761
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02007762option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007763 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7765 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007766 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007767 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7768 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02007769 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
7770 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007771
7772 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7773 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007774 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007775 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7776 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7777 in the MySQL table, like this :
7778
7779 USE mysql;
7780 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7781 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7782
7783 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007784 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007785 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7786 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7787 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7788 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7789 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7790 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7791 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7792
7793 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7794 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007795
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007796 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007797
7798 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7799 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7800 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7801 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007802 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7803 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007804
7805 See also: "option httpchk"
7806
7807
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007808option nolinger
7809no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007810 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7812 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007813 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007814
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007815 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007816 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7817 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7818 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7819 connections.
7820
7821 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7822 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7823 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7824 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7825 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7826 this too.
7827
7828 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7829 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7830 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7831
7832 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7833 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7834 for servers.
7835
7836 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7837 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7838
7839
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007840option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7841 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7843 yes | yes | yes | yes
7844 Arguments :
7845 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7846 matching <network>
7847 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7848 header name.
7849
7850 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7851 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7852 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7853 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7854 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7855 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7856 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7857 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7858 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7859 possible that the client has already brought one.
7860
7861 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7862 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7863 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7864 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7865 header and requires different one.
7866
7867 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7868 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7869 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7870 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7871 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7872 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7873 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7874
7875 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7876 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7877 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7878 both are defined.
7879
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007880 Examples :
7881 # Original Destination address
7882 frontend www
7883 mode http
7884 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7885
7886 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7887 backend www
7888 mode http
7889 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7890
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007891 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007892
7893
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007894option persist
7895no option persist
7896 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7897 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7898 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007899 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007900
7901 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7902 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7903 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7904 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7905 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7906 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7907 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7908 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7909 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7910 redirected to another valid server.
7911
7912 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7913 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7914
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007915 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007916
7917
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007918option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7919 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7921 yes | no | yes | yes
7922 Arguments :
7923 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7924 PostgreSQL server.
7925
7926 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7927 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7928 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7929 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7930
7931 See also: "option httpchk"
7932
7933
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007934option prefer-last-server
7935no option prefer-last-server
7936 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7937 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7938 yes | no | yes | yes
7939 Arguments : none
7940
7941 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7942 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7943 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7944 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7945 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7946 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7947 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7948 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7949 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007950 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7951 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007952 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7953 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7954 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007955 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7956 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7957 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007958
7959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7961
7962 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7963
7964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007965option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007966option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007967no option redispatch
7968 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7969 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7970 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007971 Arguments :
7972 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7973 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7974 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007975 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007976 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007977 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007978 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7979 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7980 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007982
7983 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7984 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7985 be able to access the service anymore.
7986
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007987 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7988 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007989
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007990 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7991 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7992 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7993 following order:
7994
7995 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7996
7997 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7998 list, or
7999
8000 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8001
8002 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8003 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8004
8005 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8006 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8007 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8008 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8009
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008010 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008011 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8012 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008014 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8015 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8016
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008017 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008018
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008019
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008020option redis-check
8021 Use redis health checks for server testing
8022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8023 yes | no | yes | yes
8024 Arguments : none
8025
8026 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8027 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8028 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8029 find the "+PONG" response message.
8030
8031 Example :
8032 option redis-check
8033
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008034 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008035
8036
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008037option smtpchk
8038option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8039 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8041 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008042 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008043 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008044 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008045 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8046
8047 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8048 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8049 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8050
8051 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8052 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8053 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8054 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8055 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8056 dead server.
8057
8058 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8059 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008060 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008061 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8062
8063 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8064 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8065 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8066 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008067 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008068
8069 Example :
8070 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8071
8072 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008074
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008075option socket-stats
8076no option socket-stats
8077
8078 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8080 yes | yes | yes | no
8081
8082 Arguments : none
8083
8084
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008085option splice-auto
8086no option splice-auto
8087 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8089 yes | yes | yes | yes
8090 Arguments : none
8091
8092 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8093 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008094 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008095 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008096 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008097 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8098 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8099 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8100 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8101
8102 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8103 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8104 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8105 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8106 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8107 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8108 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8109 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8110 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8111 keyword.
8112
8113 Example :
8114 option splice-auto
8115
8116 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8117 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8118
8119 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8120 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8121
8122
8123option splice-request
8124no option splice-request
8125 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8127 yes | yes | yes | yes
8128 Arguments : none
8129
8130 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008131 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008132 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8133 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8134 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8135 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8136
8137 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8138
8139 Example :
8140 option splice-request
8141
8142 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8143 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8144
8145 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8146 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8147
8148
8149option splice-response
8150no option splice-response
8151 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8153 yes | yes | yes | yes
8154 Arguments : none
8155
8156 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008157 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008158 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8159 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8160 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8161 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8162
8163 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8164
8165 Example :
8166 option splice-response
8167
8168 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8169 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8170
8171 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8172 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8173
8174
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008175option spop-check
8176 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8178 no | no | no | yes
8179 Arguments : none
8180
8181 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8182 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8183 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8184 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8185
8186 Example :
8187 option spop-check
8188
8189 See also : "option httpchk"
8190
8191
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008192option srvtcpka
8193no option srvtcpka
8194 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8196 yes | no | yes | yes
8197 Arguments : none
8198
8199 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8200 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008201 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008202 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8203
8204 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8205 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8206 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8207 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8208
8209 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8210 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8211 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8212 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8213 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8214
8215 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8216
8217 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8218 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8219 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8220
8221 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8222 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8223
8224 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8225
8226
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008227option ssl-hello-chk
8228 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8230 yes | no | yes | yes
8231 Arguments : none
8232
8233 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8234 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8235 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8236 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8237 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8238 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8239 hello message.
8240
8241 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8242 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8243 messages, which is appreciable.
8244
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008245 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8246 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8247 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008248
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008249 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8250
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008251
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008252option tcp-check
8253 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8254 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8255 yes | no | yes | yes
8256
8257 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8258 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8259
8260 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8261 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8262 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8263
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008264 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008265 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8266 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8267 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8268 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8269 only.
8270
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008271 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008272 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8273 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8274 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8275 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8276
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008277 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008278 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8279 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008280 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008281 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8282 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8283 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8284 the respective protocols.
8285 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008286 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008287
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008288 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008289
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008290 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8291 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8292 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8293 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008294
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008295 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8296 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8297 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008298
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008299
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008300 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008301 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008302 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008303 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008304
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008305 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008306 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008307 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008308
8309 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8310 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008311 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008312 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008313 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008314 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008315 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008316 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008317 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8318 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008319 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008320 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8321 tcp-check expect string +OK
8322
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008323 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008324 (send many headers before analyzing)
8325 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008326 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008327 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8328 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8329 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8330 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008331 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008332
8333
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008334 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008335
8336
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008337option tcp-smart-accept
8338no option tcp-smart-accept
8339 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8341 yes | yes | yes | no
8342 Arguments : none
8343
8344 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8345 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8346 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8347 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8348 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8349 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8350
8351 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8352 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8353 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8354 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8355
8356 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8357 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8358 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008359 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008360
8361 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8362 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8363 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8364
8365 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8366 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8367 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8368
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008369 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8370
8371
8372option tcp-smart-connect
8373no option tcp-smart-connect
8374 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8376 yes | no | yes | yes
8377 Arguments : none
8378
8379 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8380 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8381 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8382 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8383 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8384
8385 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8386 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8387 complex.
8388
8389 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8390 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8391 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8392
8393 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8394 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8395
8396 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8397
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008398
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008399option tcpka
8400 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8402 yes | yes | yes | yes
8403 Arguments : none
8404
8405 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8406 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008407 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008408 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8409
8410 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8411 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8412 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8413 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8414
8415 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8416 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8417 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8418 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8419 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8420
8421 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8422
8423 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8424 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8425 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8426 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8427 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8428 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8429 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8430 backends.
8431
8432 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8433
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008434
8435option tcplog
8436 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008438 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008439 Arguments : none
8440
8441 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8442 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8443 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8444 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8445 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8446 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8447 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8448 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8449
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008450 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008452 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008453
8454
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008455option transparent
8456no option transparent
8457 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008459 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008460 Arguments : none
8461
8462 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8463 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8464 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8465 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8466 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8467 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8468 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8469 appropriate server.
8470
8471 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8472 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8473
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008474 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008475 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008476
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008477
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008478external-check command <command>
8479 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8481 yes | no | yes | yes
8482
8483 Arguments :
8484 <command> is the external command to run
8485
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008486 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8487
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008488 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008489
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008490 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8491 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8492 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8493 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8494 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8495 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008496
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008497 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8498
8499 Environment variables :
8500 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8501 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8502
8503 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8504
8505 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8506
8507 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8508 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8509 for a UNIX socket).
8510
8511 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8512
8513 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8514
8515 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8516
8517 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8518
8519 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8520
8521 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8522 socket).
8523
8524 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8525 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8526
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008527 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8528
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008529 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8530 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8531 failed.
8532
8533 Example :
8534 external-check command /bin/true
8535
8536 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8537
8538
8539external-check path <path>
8540 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8542 yes | no | yes | yes
8543
8544 Arguments :
8545 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8546
8547 The default path is "".
8548
8549 Example :
8550 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8551
8552 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8553 "external-check command"
8554
8555
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008556persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008557persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008558 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8560 yes | no | yes | yes
8561 Arguments :
8562 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008563 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8564 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008565
8566 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8567 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008568 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008569 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8570 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8571 forwarded to this server.
8572
8573 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8574 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8575 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008576 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008577 a single "listen" section.
8578
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008579 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8580 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8581 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8582
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008583 Example :
8584 listen tse-farm
8585 bind :3389
8586 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8587 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8588 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8589 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8590 persist rdp-cookie
8591 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008592 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008593 balance rdp-cookie
8594 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8595 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8596
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008597 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8598 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008599
8600
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008601rate-limit sessions <rate>
8602 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8604 yes | yes | yes | no
8605 Arguments :
8606 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8607 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8608
8609 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8610 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8611 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8612 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8613 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8614 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8615
8616 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8617 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8618 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8619 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8620
8621 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8622 listen smtp
8623 mode tcp
8624 bind :25
8625 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008626 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008627
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008628 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8629 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8630 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008631
8632 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8633
8634
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008635redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8636redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8637redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008638 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8640 no | yes | yes | yes
8641
8642 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008643 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008644
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008645 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008646 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008647 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8648 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8649 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008650
8651 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8652 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8653 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8654 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8655 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008656 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8657 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8658 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8659 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008660
8661 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8662 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8663 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8664 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8665 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8666 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008667 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008668 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008669 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8670 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8671 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008672
8673 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008674 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8675 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8676 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008677 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008678 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8679 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8680 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8681 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008682
8683 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008684 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008685
8686 - "drop-query"
8687 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8688 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8689 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8690 with a location-type redirect.
8691
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008692 - "append-slash"
8693 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8694 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8695 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8696 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8697
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008698 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8699 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8700 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8701 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8702 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8703 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8704 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8705
8706 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8707 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8708 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8709 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8710 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8711 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8712 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008713
8714 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8715 acl clear dst_port 80
8716 acl secure dst_port 8080
8717 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008718 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008719 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008720 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8721
8722 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008723 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8724 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8725 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008726 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008727
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008728 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8729 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8730 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8731
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008732 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008733 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008734
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008735 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008736 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8737 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8738 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008740 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008741
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008742
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008743retries <value>
8744 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8745 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8746 yes | no | yes | yes
8747 Arguments :
8748 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8749 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8750 default value is 3.
8751
8752 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8753 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8754 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8755
8756 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008757 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8758 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008759
8760 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8761 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8762
8763 See also : "option redispatch"
8764
8765
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008766retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02008767 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
8768 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
8769 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008770 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8771 yes | no | yes | yes
8772 Arguments :
8773 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8774 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8775 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8776 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8777
8778 none never retry
8779
8780 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8781 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8782
8783 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8784 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8785 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8786 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8787 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8788 processing the request.
8789
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008790 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8791 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8792 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8793 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8794 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8795 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8796 overflow attack for example).
8797
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008798 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8799 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8800 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8801 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8802 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8803 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8804 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8805 amplify denial of service attacks.
8806
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008807 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8808 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8809 considered to be safe to retry.
8810
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008811 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8812 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8813 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8814 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8815
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008816 all-retryable-errors
8817 retry request for any error that are considered
8818 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8819 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8820 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8821
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008822 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8823 not cumulative.
8824
8825 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8826 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8827 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8828 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8829
8830 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8831 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8832 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8833 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8834 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8835 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8836 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8837 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8838 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8839 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8840 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8841 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8842
8843 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8844 should not use this directive.
8845
8846 The default is "conn-failure".
8847
8848 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8849
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008850server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008851 Declare a server in a backend
8852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8853 no | no | yes | yes
8854 Arguments :
8855 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008856 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008857 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008858
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008859 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8860 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8861 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8862 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008863 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8864 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8865 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8866 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8867 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008868 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8869 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8870 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8871 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8872 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8873 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8874 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008875 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008876 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8877 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8878 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8879 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8880 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8881 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008882 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8883 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008884 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8885 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008886
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008887 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008888 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8889 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8890 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8891 adding this value to the client's port.
8892
8893 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8894 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008895 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008896
8897 Examples :
8898 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8899 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008900 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008901 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8902 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8903 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008904
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008905 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8906 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8907 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8908 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8909 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8910
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008911 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8912 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008913
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008914server-state-file-name [<file>]
8915 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8916 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8917 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8918 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8919 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8920 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8921
8922 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8923 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8924
8925 global
8926 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8927
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008928 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008929 load-server-state-from-file
8930
8931 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8932 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008933
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008934server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8935 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8936 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8938 no | no | yes | yes
8939
8940 Arguments:
8941 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8942
8943 <num | range>
8944 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8945 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8946 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8947 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8948
8949 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8950
8951 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8952
8953 <params*>
8954 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8955 keyword.
8956
8957 Examples:
8958 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8959 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8960 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8961
8962 # or
8963 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8964
8965 # would be equivalent to:
8966 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8967 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8968 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8969
8970
8971
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008972source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008973source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008974source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008975 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8977 yes | no | yes | yes
8978 Arguments :
8979 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8980 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008981
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008982 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008983 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8984 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8985 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8986 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8987 supported prefixes are :
8988 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8989 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8990 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008991 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008992 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8993 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008994
8995 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8996 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008997 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8998 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8999 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009000
9001 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9002 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9003 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9004 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9005 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9006 <addr>.
9007
9008 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9009 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9010 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9011 port.
9012
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009013 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9014 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9015 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9016 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009017 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009018 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9019 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9020 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9021 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9022 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9023 HTTP header.
9024
9025 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9026 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009027 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009028 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9029 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9030 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9031 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9032 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9033 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9034 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9035
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009036 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9037 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9038 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9039 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9040 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9041 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9042
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009043 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9044 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9045 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9046 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9047
9048 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9049 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9050 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9051 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9052 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9053 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9054
9055 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9056 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9057 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9058 there are two methods :
9059
9060 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9061 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9062 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9063 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9064 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9065 of the client ranges may be used.
9066
9067 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9068 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9069 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9070 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9071 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9072 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9073 same session.
9074
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009075 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9076 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9077 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009078 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009079
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009080 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9081
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009082 Examples :
9083 backend private
9084 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9085 source 192.168.1.200
9086
9087 backend transparent_ssl1
9088 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9089 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9090
9091 backend transparent_ssl2
9092 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9093 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9094 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9095
9096 backend transparent_ssl3
9097 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9098 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9099 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9100
9101 backend transparent_smtp
9102 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9103 # with Tproxy version 4.
9104 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9105
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009106 backend transparent_http
9107 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9108 # proxy.
9109 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009111 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009112 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9113
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009114
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009115stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9116 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009118 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009119
9120 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9121 matched.
9122
9123 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9124 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9125
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009126 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9127 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009128 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009129
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009130 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9131 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9132 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9133 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009134
9135 Example :
9136 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9137 backend stats_localhost
9138 stats enable
9139 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9140
9141 Example :
9142 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9143 backend stats_auth
9144 stats enable
9145 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9146 stats admin if TRUE
9147
9148 Example :
9149 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9150 userlist stats-auth
9151 group admin users admin
9152 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9153 group readonly users haproxy
9154 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9155
9156 backend stats_auth
9157 stats enable
9158 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9159 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9160 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9161 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9162
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009163 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9164 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9165 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009166
9167
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009168stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9169 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009171 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009172 Arguments :
9173 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9174
9175 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9176
9177 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9178 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9179 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9180 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9181 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9182 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9183
9184 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9185 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9186 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009187 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009188
9189 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9190 report using "stats scope".
9191
9192 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9193 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9194 unobvious parameters.
9195
9196 Example :
9197 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9198 backend public_www
9199 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9200 stats enable
9201 stats hide-version
9202 stats scope .
9203 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009204 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009205 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9206 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9207
9208 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9209 backend private_monitoring
9210 stats enable
9211 stats uri /admin?stats
9212 stats refresh 5s
9213
9214 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9215
9216
9217stats enable
9218 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009220 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009221 Arguments : none
9222
9223 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9224 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9225 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9226 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9227 - stats auth : no authentication
9228 - stats scope : no restriction
9229
9230 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9231 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9232 unobvious parameters.
9233
9234 Example :
9235 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9236 backend public_www
9237 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9238 stats enable
9239 stats hide-version
9240 stats scope .
9241 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009242 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009243 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9244 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9245
9246 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9247 backend private_monitoring
9248 stats enable
9249 stats uri /admin?stats
9250 stats refresh 5s
9251
9252 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9253
9254
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009255stats hide-version
9256 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009258 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009259 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009260
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009261 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9262 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9263 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9264 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9265 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9266 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009267
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009268 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9269 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9270 unobvious parameters.
9271
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009272 Example :
9273 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9274 backend public_www
9275 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009276 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009277 stats hide-version
9278 stats scope .
9279 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009280 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009281 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9282 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009283
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009284 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9285 backend private_monitoring
9286 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009287 stats uri /admin?stats
9288 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009289
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009290 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009291
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009292
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009293stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9294 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9295 Access control for statistics
9296
9297 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9298 no | no | yes | yes
9299
9300 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9301 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9302 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9303 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9304 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9305 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9306
9307 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9308 instance.
9309
9310 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9311 about ACL usage.
9312
9313
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009314stats realm <realm>
9315 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009317 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009318 Arguments :
9319 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9320 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9321 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9322
9323 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9324 using a backslash ('\').
9325
9326 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9327 only related to authentication.
9328
9329 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9330 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9331 unobvious parameters.
9332
9333 Example :
9334 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9335 backend public_www
9336 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9337 stats enable
9338 stats hide-version
9339 stats scope .
9340 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009341 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009342 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9343 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9344
9345 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9346 backend private_monitoring
9347 stats enable
9348 stats uri /admin?stats
9349 stats refresh 5s
9350
9351 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9352
9353
9354stats refresh <delay>
9355 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009357 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009358 Arguments :
9359 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9360 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9361 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9362 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9363 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9364 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9365
9366 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9367 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9368 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9369 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9370
9371 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9372 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9373 unobvious parameters.
9374
9375 Example :
9376 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9377 backend public_www
9378 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9379 stats enable
9380 stats hide-version
9381 stats scope .
9382 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009383 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009384 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9385 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9386
9387 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9388 backend private_monitoring
9389 stats enable
9390 stats uri /admin?stats
9391 stats refresh 5s
9392
9393 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9394
9395
9396stats scope { <name> | "." }
9397 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009399 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009400 Arguments :
9401 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9402 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9403 section in which the statement appears.
9404
9405 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9406 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9407 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9408 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9409 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9410 exists.
9411
9412 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9413 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9414 unobvious parameters.
9415
9416 Example :
9417 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9418 backend public_www
9419 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9420 stats enable
9421 stats hide-version
9422 stats scope .
9423 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009424 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009425 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9426 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9427
9428 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9429 backend private_monitoring
9430 stats enable
9431 stats uri /admin?stats
9432 stats refresh 5s
9433
9434 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9435
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009436
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009437stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009438 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009440 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009441
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009442 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009443 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9444
9445 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9446 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9447
9448 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9449 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009450 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009451
9452 Example :
9453 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9454 backend private_monitoring
9455 stats enable
9456 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9457 stats uri /admin?stats
9458 stats refresh 5s
9459
9460 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9461 global section.
9462
9463
9464stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009465 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9467 yes | yes | yes | yes
9468 Arguments : none
9469
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009470 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009471 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9472 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9473 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9474 - IP (socket, server)
9475 - cookie (backend, server)
9476
9477 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9478 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009479 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009480
9481 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9482
9483
9484stats show-node [ <name> ]
9485 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009487 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009488 Arguments:
9489 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9490 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9491
9492 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9493 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009494 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009495
9496 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9497 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9498 unobvious parameters.
9499
9500 Example:
9501 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9502 backend private_monitoring
9503 stats enable
9504 stats show-node Europe-1
9505 stats uri /admin?stats
9506 stats refresh 5s
9507
9508 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9509 section.
9510
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009511
9512stats uri <prefix>
9513 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009515 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009516 Arguments :
9517 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9518 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9519 query string.
9520
9521 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9522 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9523 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9524 possible to reach it in the application.
9525
9526 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009527 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009528 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9529 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9530 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9531 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9532
9533 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9534 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9535 an address or a port to statistics only.
9536
9537 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9538 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9539 unobvious parameters.
9540
9541 Example :
9542 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9543 backend public_www
9544 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9545 stats enable
9546 stats hide-version
9547 stats scope .
9548 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009549 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009550 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9551 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9552
9553 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9554 backend private_monitoring
9555 stats enable
9556 stats uri /admin?stats
9557 stats refresh 5s
9558
9559 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9560
9561
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009562stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9563 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009565 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009566
9567 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009568 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009569 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009570 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009571 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9572
9573 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9574 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9575 the "stick-table" statement.
9576
9577 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9578 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9579 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9580 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9581 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9582
9583 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9584 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9585 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9586 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9587 transformation rules.
9588
9589 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9590 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9591 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9592 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9593 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9594 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9595 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9596
9597 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9598 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9599 ACL based conditions.
9600
9601 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9602 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9603 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9604 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9605
9606 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9607 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9608 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9609 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9610
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009611 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9612 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009613 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009614
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009615 Example :
9616 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9617 # last 30 minutes
9618 backend pop
9619 mode tcp
9620 balance roundrobin
9621 stick store-request src
9622 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9623 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9624 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9625
9626 backend smtp
9627 mode tcp
9628 balance roundrobin
9629 stick match src table pop
9630 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9631 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9632
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009633 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009634 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009635
9636
9637stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9638 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9640 no | no | yes | yes
9641
9642 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9643 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9644 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9645 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9646
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009647 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9648 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009649 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009650
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009651 Examples :
9652 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009653 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009654
9655 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9656 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9657 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9658
9659
9660 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9661 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9662 backend http
9663 mode http
9664 balance roundrobin
9665 stick on src table https
9666 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9667 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9668 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9669
9670 backend https
9671 mode tcp
9672 balance roundrobin
9673 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9674 stick on src
9675 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9676 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9677
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009678 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009679
9680
9681stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9682 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9684 no | no | yes | yes
9685
9686 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009687 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009688 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009689 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009690 server is selected.
9691
9692 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9693 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9694 the "stick-table" statement.
9695
9696 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9697 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9698 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9699 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9700 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9701 address.
9702
9703 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9704 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9705 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9706 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9707 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9708 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9709 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9710 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9711 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9712 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9713
9714 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9715 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9716 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9717 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9718 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9719 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9720 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9721
9722 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9723 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9724 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9725 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9726
9727 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9728 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9729 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9730 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9731 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9732 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009733 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9734 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9735 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9736 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9737 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9738 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009739
9740 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9741 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9742 the request.
9743
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009744 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9745 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009746 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009747
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009748 Example :
9749 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9750 # last 30 minutes
9751 backend pop
9752 mode tcp
9753 balance roundrobin
9754 stick store-request src
9755 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9756 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9757 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9758
9759 backend smtp
9760 mode tcp
9761 balance roundrobin
9762 stick match src table pop
9763 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9764 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9765
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009766 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009767 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009768
9769
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009770stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009771 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9772 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009773 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009775 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009776
9777 Arguments :
9778 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9779 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9780 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9781 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9782
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009783 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9784 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9785 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9786 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9787
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009788 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9789 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9790 instance.
9791
9792 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9793 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9794 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9795 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9796 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9797 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009798 to 32 characters.
9799
9800 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9801 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9802 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009803 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009804 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9805 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009806
9807 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009808 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9809 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009810 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9811 increase.
9812
9813 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009814 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9815 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9816 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009817
9818 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9819 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9820 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9821 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009822 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009823 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9824 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9825 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9826 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9827 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9828 parameter (see below).
9829
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009830 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9831 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9832 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9833 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9834 soft restart.
9835
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009836 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9837 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009838
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009839 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9840 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9841 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9842 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009843 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009844 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009845 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9846 if not expiration delay is specified.
9847
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009848 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9849 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9850 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9851 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009852 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9853 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9854 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9855 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9856 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9857 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9858 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9859 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9860 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9861 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9862 types and their arguments.
9863
9864 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9865 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9866 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9867 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9868
9869 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9870 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9871 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009872 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009873
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009874 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9875 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9876 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009877 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009878 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009879 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009880
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009881 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9882 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9883 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9884 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9885
9886 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9887 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9888 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9889 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9890 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9891 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9892
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009893 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9894 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9895 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9896 they were received.
9897
9898 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9899 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9900 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9901 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9902 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9903
9904 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9905 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9906 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9907 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9908 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9909
9910 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9911 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9912 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9913
9914 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9915 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9916 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9917 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9918 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9919
9920 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9921 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9922 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9923 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9924 the client side.
9925
9926 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9927 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9928 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9929 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9930 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9931 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9932 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9933
9934 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9935 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9936 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9937 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9938 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9939 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009940 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009941
9942 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9943 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9944 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9945 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9946 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9947 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9948
9949 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009950 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009951 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9952 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9953
9954 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9955 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9956 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9957 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9958 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9959 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9960 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9961 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9962 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9963 recommended for better fairness.
9964
9965 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009966 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009967 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9968 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9969
9970 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9971 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9972 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9973 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9974 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9975 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9976 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9977 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9978 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9979 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009980
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009981 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9982 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009983 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9984 reference it.
9985
9986 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9987 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009988 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9989 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9990 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009991
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009992 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9993 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9994 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9995 something that can be ignored.
9996
9997 Example:
9998 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9999 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10000 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10001 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10002
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010003 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010004 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010005
10006
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010007stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010008 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10010 no | no | yes | yes
10011
10012 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010013 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010014 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010015 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010016 server is selected.
10017
10018 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10019 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10020 the "stick-table" statement.
10021
10022 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10023 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10024 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10025 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10026
10027 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10028 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10029 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10030 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10031 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10032 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010033 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010034 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10035 rules.
10036
10037 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10038 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10039 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10040 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10041 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10042 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10043 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10044
10045 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10046 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10047 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10048 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10049
10050 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10051 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10052 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10053 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10054 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10055 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010056 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10057 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10058 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10059 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10060 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10061 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10062 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10063 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10064 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010065
10066 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10067
10068 Example :
10069 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10070 backend https
10071 mode tcp
10072 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010073 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010074 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010075
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010076 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10077 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10078
10079 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10080 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10081 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10082
10083 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10084 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010085
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010086 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10087 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10088 # at offset 44.
10089
10090 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10091 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10092
10093 # Learn on response if server hello.
10094 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010095
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010096 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10097 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10098
10099 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10100 extraction.
10101
10102
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010103tcp-check comment <string>
10104 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10105 it fails.
10106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10107 yes | no | yes | yes
10108
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010109 Arguments :
10110 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10111 rule fails.
10112
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010113 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10114 user-friendly error reporting.
10115
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010116 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10117 "tcp-check expect".
10118
10119
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010120tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10121 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010122 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010123 Opens a new connection
10124 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010125 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010126
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010127 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010128 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10129
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010130 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010131 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010132
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010133 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010134 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10135 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010136 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010137
10138 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010139
10140 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10141
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010142 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10143
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010144 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10145
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010146 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10147
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010148 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10149 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10150 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10151 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10152
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010153 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10154 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10155 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10156 haproxy -vv.
10157
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010158 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010159
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010160 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10161 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10162 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10163
10164 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10165 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10166 of the sequence.
10167
10168 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10169 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10170 do.
10171
10172 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10173 unset-var or comment rules.
10174
10175 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010176 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10177 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10178 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10179 option tcp-check
10180 tcp-check connect
10181 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10182 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10183 tcp-check send \r\n
10184 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10185 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10186 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10187 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10188 tcp-check send \r\n
10189 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10190 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10191
10192 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10193 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010194 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010195 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10196 tcp-check connect port 143
10197 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10198 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10199
10200 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10201
10202
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010203tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010204 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010205 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010206 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010207 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010208 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010209 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010210
10211 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010212 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10213
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010214 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10215 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10216 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10217 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10218 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10219 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10220 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10221 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10222 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10223 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10224
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010225 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010226 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10227 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010228 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10229 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10230 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10231
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010232 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10233 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10234 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010235 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10236 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10237 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10238 example 404 with disable-on-404
10239 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10240 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010241 By default "L7OK" is used.
10242
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010243 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10244 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010245 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10246 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10247 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10248 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10249 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10250 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010251
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010252 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010253 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010254 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10255 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10256 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10257 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010258 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10259
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010260 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10261 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10262 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10263 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10264
10265 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10266 informational message reported in logs if an error
10267 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10268 log-format string.
10269
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010270 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10271 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10272 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10273 followed by some converters.
10274
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010275 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10276 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10277 with the usual backslash ('\').
10278 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010279 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010280 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10281 used upper or lower case.
10282
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010283 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10284
10285 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10286 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10287 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10288 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10289 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10290 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10291 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10292 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10293
10294 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10295 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10296 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10297 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10298 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10299 expression.
10300
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010301 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10302 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10303 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10304 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10305 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10306 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10307
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010308 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10309 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10310 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10311 this exact hexadecimal string.
10312 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10313
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010314 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10315 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10316 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10317 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10318 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10319 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10320 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10321 size.
10322
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010323 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10324 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10325 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10326 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10327 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10328 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10329 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10330 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10331 in a binary string before matching the response's
10332 buffer.
10333
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010334 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10335 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10336 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10337 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10338 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10339 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10340 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10341 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10342 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10343 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10344 the null character.
10345
10346 Examples :
10347 # perform a POP check
10348 option tcp-check
10349 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10350
10351 # perform an IMAP check
10352 option tcp-check
10353 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10354
10355 # look for the redis master server
10356 option tcp-check
10357 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010358 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010359 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10360 tcp-check expect string role:master
10361 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10362 tcp-check expect string +OK
10363
10364
10365 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10366 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10367
10368
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010369tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10370tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10371 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10372 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010373 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010374 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010375
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010376 Arguments :
10377 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10378
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010379 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10380 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010381
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010382 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10383 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010384
10385 Examples :
10386 # look for the redis master server
10387 option tcp-check
10388 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10389 tcp-check expect string role:master
10390
10391 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10392 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10393
10394
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010395tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10396tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10397 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10398 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010399 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010400 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010401
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010402 Arguments :
10403 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010404
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010405 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10406 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010407
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010408 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10409 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10410 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010411
10412 Examples :
10413 # redis check in binary
10414 option tcp-check
10415 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10416 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10417
10418
10419 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10420 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10421
10422
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010423tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010424 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010426 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010427
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010428 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010429 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10430 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10431 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10432 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10433 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10434 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10435 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10436 and '-'.
10437
10438 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10439
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010440 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010441 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10442
10443
10444tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010445 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010446 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010447 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010448
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010449 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010450 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10451 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10452 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10453 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10454 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10455 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10456 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10457 and '-'.
10458
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010459 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010460 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10461
10462
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010463tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10464 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10466 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010467 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010468 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10469 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010470
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010471 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010472
10473 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10474 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010475 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10476 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10477 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10478 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10479 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10480 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010481
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010482 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10483 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10484 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10485 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010486
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010487 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010488 - accept :
10489 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10490 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10491 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010492
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010493 - reject :
10494 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10495 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10496 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10497 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10498 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10499 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10500 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10501 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10502 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10503 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10504 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010505 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010506
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010507 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10508 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10509 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10510 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10511 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10512 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10513 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10514 hosts.
10515
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010516 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10517 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10518 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10519 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10520 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10521 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10522 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10523 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10524
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010525 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10526 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10527 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10528 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10529 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10530 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10531 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10532 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10533 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010534 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10535 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010536
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010537 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010538 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010539 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10540 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10541 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010542 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010543 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10544 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10545 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10546 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10547 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10548 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10549 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10550 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010551
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010552 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010553 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010554 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010555 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010556 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10557 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10558 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010559
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010560 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10561 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10562 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10563 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010564
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010565 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10566 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10567 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10568 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10569 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010570 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10571 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10572 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10573 layer7 information is extracted.
10574
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010575 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10576 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10577 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10578 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10579 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010580
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010581 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10582 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10583 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10584 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10585
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010586 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10587 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10588 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10589 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10590
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010591 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10592 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10593 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10594 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10595 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010596
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010597 - set-src <expr> :
10598 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10599 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10600 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010601 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010602
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010603 Arguments:
10604 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10605 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010606
10607 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010608 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10609
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010610 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10611 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010612
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010613 - set-src-port <expr> :
10614 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10615 expression.
10616
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010617 Arguments:
10618 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10619 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010620
10621 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010622 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10623
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010624 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10625 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10626 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010627
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010628 - set-dst <expr> :
10629 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10630 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10631 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10632 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10633 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10634
10635 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10636 followed by some converters.
10637
10638 Example:
10639
10640 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10641 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10642
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010643 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10644 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10645
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010646 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10647 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10648 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10649 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10650
10651
10652 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10653 followed by some converters.
10654
10655 Example:
10656
10657 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10658
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010659 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10660 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10661 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10662
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010663 - "silent-drop" :
10664 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010665 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010666 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10667 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10668 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10669 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10670 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010671 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10672 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010673 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10674 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010675 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010676 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10677 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10678 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10679 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10680
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010681 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10682 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10683 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010684
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010685 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10686 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10687 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010688
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010689 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010690 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010691 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010692
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010693 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10694 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10695 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010696
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010697 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010698 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10699 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010700
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010701 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10702
10703 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10704
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010705 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10706
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010707 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010708
10709
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010710tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10711 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010713 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010714 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010715 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10716 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010717
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010718 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010719
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010720 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010721 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10722 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10723 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10724 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010725
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010726 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10727 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10728 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10729 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010730 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10731 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10732 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10733 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10734 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10735 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010736 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010737 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010738
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010739 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10740 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10741 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10742 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010743
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010744 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010745 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010746 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010747 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10748 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010749 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010750 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010751 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010752 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010753 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010754 - set-dst <expr>
10755 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010756 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010757 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010758 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010759 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010760 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010761
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010762 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10763 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010764 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10765 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010766
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010767 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10768 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10769 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10770 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10771 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10772 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010774 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010775 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10776 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010777
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010778 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010779 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10780 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10781 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10782 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010783 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10784 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10785 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010786
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010787 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010788 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10789 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10790 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010791
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010792 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10793 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10794
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010795 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010796 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10797 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010798
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010799 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10800 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010801 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010802 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10803 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010804 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010805 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010806 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010807 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10808 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010809 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010810 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10811 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010812
10813 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10814 followed by some converters.
10815
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010816 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10817 <var-name>.
10818
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010819 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10820 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10821 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10822 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10823 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10824
10825 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10826 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10827 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10828 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10829 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10830 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10831 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10832 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10833 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10834 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10835 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10836
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010837 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10838 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10839 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10840 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10841 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10842
10843 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10844
10845 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10846
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010847 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10848 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10849 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10850 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10851 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10852 evaluated.
10853
10854 Example:
10855 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10856
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010857 Example:
10858
10859 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010860 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010861
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010862 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010863 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10864 # and reject everything else.
10865 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10866 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010867 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010868 tcp-request content reject
10869
10870 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010871 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10872 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10873 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010874 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010875
10876 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10877 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10878 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010879 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010880 tcp-request content reject
10881
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010882 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010883 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010884 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010885 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010886 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10887 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010888
10889 Example:
10890 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10891 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010892 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010893
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010894 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010895 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010896
10897 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010898 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010899 # protecting all our sites
10900 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010901 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10902 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010903 ...
10904 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10905
10906 backend http_dynamic
10907 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010908 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010909 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010910 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010911 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010912 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010913 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010915 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010916
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010917 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10918 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010919
10920
10921tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10922 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010924 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010925 Arguments :
10926 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10927 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10928 as explained at the top of this document.
10929
10930 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10931 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10932 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10933 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10934 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10935
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010936 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10937 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10938 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10939 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10940
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010941 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10942 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010943 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010944 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010945 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10946 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10947 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10948 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010949
10950 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10951 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10952 it pass through unaffected.
10953
10954 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10955 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10956 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010957 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010958 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10959 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010960 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10961 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10962 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010963
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010964 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010965 "timeout client".
10966
10967
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010968tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10969 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10971 no | no | yes | yes
10972 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010973 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10974 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010975
10976 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10977
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010978 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010979 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10980 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010981 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10982 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010983
10984 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10985
10986 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10987 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10988 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10989 inserted.
10990
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010991 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010992 - accept :
10993 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10994 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10995 the rules evaluation.
10996
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010997 - close :
10998 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10999 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11000 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11001 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11002 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11003 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011004 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011005 protocols.
11006
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011007 - reject :
11008 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11009 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011010 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011011
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011012 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11013 Sets a variable.
11014
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011015 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11016 Unsets a variable.
11017
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011018 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11019 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11020 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11021 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11022
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011023 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11024 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11025 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11026 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11027
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011028 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11029 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11030 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11031 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11032 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011033
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011034 - "silent-drop" :
11035 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011036 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011037 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11038 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11039 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11040 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11041 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011042 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11043 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011044 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11045 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011046 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011047 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11048 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11049 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11050 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11051
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011052 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11053 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11054
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011055 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11056 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11057 for changing the default action to a reject.
11058
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011059 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11060 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11061 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11062 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011063 period.
11064
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011065 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11066 declared inline.
11067
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011068 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11069 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011070 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011071 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11072 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011073 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011074 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011075 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011076 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11077 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011078 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011079 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11080 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011081
11082 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11083 followed by some converters.
11084
11085 Example:
11086
11087 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11088
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011089 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11090 <var-name>.
11091
11092 Example:
11093
11094 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11095
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011096 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11097 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11098 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11099 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11100 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11101
11102 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11103
11104 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11105
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011106 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11107
11108 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11109
11110
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011111tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11112 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11114 no | yes | yes | no
11115 Arguments :
11116 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11117 below.
11118
11119 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011121 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011122 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11123 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11124 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11125 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11126 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11127 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11128 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011129 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011130 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11131 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11132 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11133 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11134 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11135 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11136 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11137 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11138 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11139 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11140 instead.
11141
11142 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11143 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11144 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11145 rules which may be inserted.
11146
11147 Several types of actions are supported :
11148 - accept : the request is accepted
11149 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11150 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11151 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011152 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011153 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011154 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011155 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011156 - silent-drop
11157
11158 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11159 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11160 sections for a complete description.
11161
11162 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11163 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11164 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11165
11166 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11167 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11168 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11169 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11170 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11171
11172 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11173 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11174
11175 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11176 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11177 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11178
11179 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11180 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11181 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11182
11183 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11184 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11185 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11186
11187 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11188 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11189 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11190
11191 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11192
11193 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11194
11195
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011196tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11197 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11199 no | no | yes | yes
11200 Arguments :
11201 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11202 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11203 as explained at the top of this document.
11204
11205 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11206
11207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011208timeout check <timeout>
11209 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11210 established.
11211
11212 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11213 yes | no | yes | yes
11214 Arguments:
11215 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11216 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11217 as explained at the top of this document.
11218
11219 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11220 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011221 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011222 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011223 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11224 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11225 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011226
11227 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11228 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11229
11230 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11231 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011232 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011233
11234 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11235 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11236 forget about it.
11237
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011238 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11239 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011240
11241
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011242timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011243 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11245 yes | yes | yes | no
11246 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011247 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011248 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11249 as explained at the top of this document.
11250
11251 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11252 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11253 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011254 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11255 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11256 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11257 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011258 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11259 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11260 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011261 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011262 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011263 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11264 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011265 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11266 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011267
11268 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11269 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11270 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11271 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011272 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011273 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011275 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011276
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011277 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011278
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011279
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011280timeout client-fin <timeout>
11281 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11283 yes | yes | yes | no
11284 Arguments :
11285 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11286 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11287 as explained at the top of this document.
11288
11289 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11290 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11291 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11292 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11293 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11294 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11295 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011296 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11297 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11298 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011299
11300 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11301 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11302 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11303
11304 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11305
11306
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011307timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011308 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11310 yes | no | yes | yes
11311 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011312 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011313 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11314 as explained at the top of this document.
11315
11316 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011317 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011318 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011319 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011320 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11321 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011322
11323 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11324 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11325 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11326 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011327 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011328 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11329
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011330 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011332
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011333timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11334 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11336 yes | yes | yes | yes
11337 Arguments :
11338 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11339 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11340 as explained at the top of this document.
11341
11342 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11343 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11344 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11345 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11346 once the request has started to present itself.
11347
11348 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11349 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11350 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11351 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11352 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11353
11354 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11355 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11356 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11357 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11358
11359 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11360 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011361 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011362 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11363 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011364 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011365
11366 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11367 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11368 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11369 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11370
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011371 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11372 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011373 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11374
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011375 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11376
11377
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011378timeout http-request <timeout>
11379 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011381 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011382 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011383 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011384 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11385 as explained at the top of this document.
11386
11387 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11388 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11389 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11390 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11391 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11392 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11393 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011394 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11395 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11396 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11397 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011398 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011399 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11400 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011401
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011402 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11403 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11404 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11405 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11406 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011407 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011408
11409 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11410 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011411 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011412 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11413 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11414
11415 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011416 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11417 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11418 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011419
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011420 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011421 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011422
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011423
11424timeout queue <timeout>
11425 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11427 yes | no | yes | yes
11428 Arguments :
11429 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11430 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11431 as explained at the top of this document.
11432
11433 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11434 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11435 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11436 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11437 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11438
11439 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11440 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11441 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11442 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11443
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011444 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011445
11446
11447timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011448 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11450 yes | no | yes | yes
11451 Arguments :
11452 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11453 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11454 as explained at the top of this document.
11455
11456 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11457 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11458 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11459 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11460 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11461 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11462 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11463
11464 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11465 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11466 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11467 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11468 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011469 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011470 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011471 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11472 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011473 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11474 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011475
11476 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11477 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11478 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11479 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011480 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011481 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11482
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011483 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011484
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011485
11486timeout server-fin <timeout>
11487 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11489 yes | no | yes | yes
11490 Arguments :
11491 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11492 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11493 as explained at the top of this document.
11494
11495 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11496 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11497 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11498 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11499 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11500 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11501 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11502 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11503 situations, it should not be needed.
11504
11505 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11506 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11507 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11508
11509 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11510
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011511
11512timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011513 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11515 yes | yes | yes | yes
11516 Arguments :
11517 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11518 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11519 as explained at the top of this document.
11520
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011521 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11522 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11523 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011524
11525 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11526 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11527 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11528 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011529 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011530
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011531 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011532
11533
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011534timeout tunnel <timeout>
11535 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11537 yes | no | yes | yes
11538 Arguments :
11539 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11540 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11541 as explained at the top of this document.
11542
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011543 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011544 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11545 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11546 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011547 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11548 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011549 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11550 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11551 specified.
11552
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011553 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11554 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11555 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11556 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11557 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11558 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11559 state.
11560
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011561 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11562 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11563 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11564 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011565 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011566
11567 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11568 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11569 forget about it.
11570
11571 Example :
11572 defaults http
11573 option http-server-close
11574 timeout connect 5s
11575 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011576 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011577 timeout server 30s
11578 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11579
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011580 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011581
11582
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011583transparent (deprecated)
11584 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011586 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011587 Arguments : none
11588
11589 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11590 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11591 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11592 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11593 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11594 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11595 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11596 appropriate server.
11597
11598 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11599
11600 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11601 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11602
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011603 See also: "option transparent"
11604
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011605unique-id-format <string>
11606 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11608 yes | yes | yes | no
11609 Arguments :
11610 <string> is a log-format string.
11611
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011612 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11613 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11614 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11615 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011616
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011617 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11618 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11619 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11620 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11621 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11622 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11623 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11624 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011625
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011626 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11627 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011628
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011629 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011630
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011631 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011632
11633 will generate:
11634
11635 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11636
11637 See also: "unique-id-header"
11638
11639unique-id-header <name>
11640 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11642 yes | yes | yes | no
11643 Arguments :
11644 <name> is the name of the header.
11645
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011646 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11647 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011648
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011649 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011650
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011651 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011652 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11653
11654 will generate:
11655
11656 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11657
11658 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011659
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011660use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011661 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11663 no | yes | yes | no
11664 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011665 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11666 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011667
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011668 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11669 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011670
11671 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11672 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11673 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011674 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011675 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011676 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11677 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011678
11679 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11680 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11681 assign the backend.
11682
11683 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11684 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11685 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11686 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11687 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11688 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11689
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011690 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011691 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011692 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11693 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11694 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11695
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011696 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11697 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11698 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11699 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11700 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11701 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11702 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11703 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11704 cannot be forced from the request.
11705
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011706 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011707 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11708 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11709
11710 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11711 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011712
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011713use-fcgi-app <name>
11714 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11716 no | no | yes | yes
11717 Arguments :
11718 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11719
11720 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011721
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011722use-server <server> if <condition>
11723use-server <server> unless <condition>
11724 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11726 no | no | yes | yes
11727 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011728 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11729 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011730
11731 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11732
11733 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11734 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11735 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11736
11737 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11738 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11739 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11740 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11741 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11742 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11743 matches will assign the server.
11744
11745 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11746 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11747 with the next rules until one matches.
11748
11749 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11750 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11751 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11752 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11753
11754 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11755 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11756 stripped.
11757
11758 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11759 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11760 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11761 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11762
11763 Example :
11764 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11765 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11766 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11767 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11768 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11769 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011770 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011771 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11772 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11773
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011774 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11775 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11776 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11777 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11778 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11779 and we fall back to load balancing.
11780
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011781 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011782
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011783
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100117845. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011785--------------------------
11786
11787The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11788depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11789settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11790written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11791described in this section.
11792
11793
117945.1. Bind options
11795-----------------
11796
11797The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11798as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11799no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11800parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11801while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11802provided immediately after the setting name.
11803
11804The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11805
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011806accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11807 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11808 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11809 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11810 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11811 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11812 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11813 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11814 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11815 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011816 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11817 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11818 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011819
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011820accept-proxy
11821 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011822 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11823 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011824 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11825 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11826 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11827 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011828 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011829 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11830 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011831 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11832 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011833
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011834allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011835 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011836 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011837 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011838 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11839 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011840
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011841alpn <protocols>
11842 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11843 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11844 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011845 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011846 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011847 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11848 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11849 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11850 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11851 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11852 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11853 preference, like below :
11854
11855 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011856
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011857backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011858 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011859 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11860
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011861curves <curves>
11862 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11863 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11864 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11865 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11866 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11867 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11868
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011869ecdhe <named curve>
11870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011871 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11872 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011873
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011874ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11876 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11877 client's certificate.
11878
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011879ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11881 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11882 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11883 error is ignored.
11884
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011885ca-sign-file <cafile>
11886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11887 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11888 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11889 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11890 'generate-certificates' for details.
11891
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011892ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11894 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11895 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11896 'generate-certificates' for details.
11897
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011898ca-verify-file <cafile>
11899 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11900 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11901 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11902 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11903 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11904
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011905ciphers <ciphers>
11906 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11907 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011908 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011909 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011910 information and recommendations see e.g.
11911 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11912 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11913 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11914
11915ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11917 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11918 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11919 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011920 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11921 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011922
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011923crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11925 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11926 to verify client's certificate.
11927
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011928crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011929 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11930 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11931 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11932 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11933 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011934 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11935 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011936
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011937 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11938 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11939
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011940 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11941 are loaded.
11942
11943 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011944 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11945 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11946 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11947 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11948 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11949 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11950 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011951 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011952
11953 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11954 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11955 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11956 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011957 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11958 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011959
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011960 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011961
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011962 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011963 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011964 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11965 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011966 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11967 clients).
11968
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011969 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11970 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11971 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11972 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11973 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11974 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11975 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11976 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11977 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11978 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11979 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11980 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11981 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11982
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011983 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11984 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11985 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11986 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11987 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11988
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011989 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11990 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11991 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11992 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011993
11994 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11995 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11996 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11997 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11998 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11999 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12000 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12001 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12002 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12003
12004 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12005
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012006 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012007 a cert bundle.
12008
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012009 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012010 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12011 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12012 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12013 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12014 provide multi-cert support.
12015
12016 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12017
12018 Filename | CN | SAN
12019 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12020 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012021 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012022 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12023 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12024
12025 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12026 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12027 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12028 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012029 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12030 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12031 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012032
12033 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12034 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12035
12036 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12037 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12038 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12039
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012040crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012041 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012042 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012043 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012044 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012045
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012046crt-list <file>
12047 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012048 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12049 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012050
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012051 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12052
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012053 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12054 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
12055 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
12056 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012057
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012058 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12059 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12060 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12061 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12062 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12063 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12064 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12065 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012066
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012067 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012068 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012069 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12070 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12071 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012072
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012073 crt-list file example:
12074 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012075 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012076 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012077 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012078
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012079defer-accept
12080 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12081 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12082 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012083 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012084 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12085 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12086 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12087 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12088 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12089 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12090 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12091
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012092expose-fd listeners
12093 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12094 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012095 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12096 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012097 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012098
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012099force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012100 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012101 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012102 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012103 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012104
12105force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012106 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012107 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012108 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012109
12110force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012111 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012112 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012113 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012114
12115force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012116 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012117 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012118 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012119
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012120force-tlsv13
12121 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12122 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012123 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012124
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012125generate-certificates
12126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12127 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12128 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12129 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12130 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12131 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12132 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12133 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12134 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12135 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12136 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12137
12138 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12139 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012140 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012141 certificate is used many times.
12142
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012143gid <gid>
12144 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12145 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12146 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12147 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12148 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12149
12150group <group>
12151 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12152 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12153 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12154 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12155 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12156
12157id <id>
12158 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12159 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12160 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12161 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12162
12163interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012164 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12165 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12166 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12167 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12168 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12169 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012170 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12171 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12172 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12173 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12174 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12175 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012176
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012177level <level>
12178 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12179 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12180 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012181 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012182 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12183 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12184 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012185 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012186 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012187 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012188 all counters).
12189
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012190severity-output <format>
12191 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12192 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12193 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12194 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12195 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12196 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12197 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12198 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12199 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12200 rfc5424 convention.
12201
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012202maxconn <maxconn>
12203 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12204 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12205 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12206 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12207 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12208 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12209 eat all memory.
12210
12211mode <mode>
12212 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12213 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12214 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12215 UNIX sockets.
12216
12217mss <maxseg>
12218 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12219 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12220 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12221 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12222 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12223 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12224 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12225 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12226 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12227 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12228 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12229
12230name <name>
12231 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12232 page.
12233
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012234namespace <name>
12235 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12236 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12237 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12238 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12239
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012240nice <nice>
12241 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12242 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12243 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12244 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12245 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12246 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12247 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12248 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12249 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12250 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12251 one for an RDP socket.
12252
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012253no-ca-names
12254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12255 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012256 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012257
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012258no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012259 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012260 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012261 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012262 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012263 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12264 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012265
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012266no-tls-tickets
12267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12268 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12269 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012270 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12271 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012272 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12273 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12274 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012275
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012276no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012278 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012279 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012280 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012281 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12282 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012283
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012284no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012285 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012286 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012287 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012288 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012289 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12290 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012291
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012292no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012294 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012295 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012296 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012297 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12298 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012299
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012300no-tlsv13
12301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12302 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12303 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12304 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012305 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12306 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012307
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012308npn <protocols>
12309 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12310 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12311 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012312 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012313 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012314 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12315 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12316 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12317 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12318 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012319
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012320prefer-client-ciphers
12321 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12322 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12323 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012324 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12325 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12326 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012327
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012328process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012329 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012330 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012331 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012332 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12333 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12334 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12335 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012336 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012337 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12338 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12339 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12340 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12341 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012342
12343 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12344
12345 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12346 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12347 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12348 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12349 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12350 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12351 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12352 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012353
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012354proto <name>
12355 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12356 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12357 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12358 in haproxy -vv.
12359 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12360 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012361 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012362 h2" on the bind line.
12363
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012364ssl
12365 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012366 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012367 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12368 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012369 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12370 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012371
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012372ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12373 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
12374 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12375 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12376
12377ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12378 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
12379 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12380 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12381
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012382strict-sni
12383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12384 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12385 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12386 See the "crt" option for more information.
12387
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012388tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012389 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012390 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12391 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012392 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012393 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12394 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12395 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12396 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12397 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12398 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12399 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12400
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012401tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012402 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012403 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12404 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12405 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12406 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12407 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12408 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12409 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012410 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12411 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12412 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012413
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012414tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12415 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012416 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12417 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12418 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12419 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12420 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12421 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12422 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12423 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12424 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12425 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012426 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12427 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12428
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012429transparent
12430 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12431 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12432 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12433 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12434 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12435 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12436 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12437 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12438 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12439 so check for support with your vendor.
12440
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012441v4v6
12442 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12443 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12444 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12445 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012446 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012447
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012448v6only
12449 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12450 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12451 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012452 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12453 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012454
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012455uid <uid>
12456 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12457 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12458 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12459 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12460 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12461
12462user <user>
12463 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12464 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12465 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12466 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12467 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12468
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012469verify [none|optional|required]
12470 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12471 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12472 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12473 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12474 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012475 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12476 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12477 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12478 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012479
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200124805.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012481------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012483The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12484which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12485arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12486settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12487after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12488Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12489address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012491 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012492 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012493
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012494Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12495keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012497The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012498
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012499addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012500 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012501 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12502 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12503 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12504 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12505 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012506
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012507agent-check
12508 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012509 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012510 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12511 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12512 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012513
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012514 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012515 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012516 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12517 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12518 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012519
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012520 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12521 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12522 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12523 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12524 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012525
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012526 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012527 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012528
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012529 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12530 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12531 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012532
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012533 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12534 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12535 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012536
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012537 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12538 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12539 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12540 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12541 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012542 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012543 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012544
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012545 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12546 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012547
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012548 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12549 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12550 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12551 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12552 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12553 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12554 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12555 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12556 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012557
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012558 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12559 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012560 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12561 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12562 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012563 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012564
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012565 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012566 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012567
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012568agent-send <string>
12569 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12570 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12571 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12572 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12573 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12574
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012575agent-inter <delay>
12576 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12577 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12578
12579 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12580 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12581 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12582 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12583 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12584 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12585 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12586 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12587 of backends use the same servers.
12588
12589 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12590
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012591agent-addr <addr>
12592 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12593
12594 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12595 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12596 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12597 hostname, it will be resolved.
12598
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012599agent-port <port>
12600 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12601
12602 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12603
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012604allow-0rtt
12605 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012606 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12607 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012608
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012609alpn <protocols>
12610 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12611 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12612 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012613 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012614 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12615 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12616 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12617 now obsolete NPN extension.
12618 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12619 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12620
12621 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012623backup
12624 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12625 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12626 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12627 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012628 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12629 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012630
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012631ca-file <cafile>
12632 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12633 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12634 server's certificate.
12635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012636check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012637 This option enables health checks on a server:
12638 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12639 considered available.
12640 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12641 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12642 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12643 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12644 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12645 set.
12646 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12647 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12648 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12649 exchanges succeed.
12650
12651 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12652 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12653 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12654 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12655 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050012656 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012657 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12658
12659 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12660 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12661
12662 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12663 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12664
12665 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12666 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12667 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12668 available.
12669
12670 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12671 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12672 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12673
12674 Example:
12675 # simple tcp check
12676 backend foo
12677 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12678 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12679 backend foo
12680 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12681 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12682 backend foo
12683 option tcp-check
12684 tcp-check connect
12685 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012686
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012687check-send-proxy
12688 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12689 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12690 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12691 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12692 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12693 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12694 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12695
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012696check-alpn <protocols>
12697 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12698 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12699 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12700
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012701check-proto <name>
12702 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
12703 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
12704 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
12705 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
12706 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12707 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
12708 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
12709
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012710check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012711 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012712 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12713 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012714
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012715check-ssl
12716 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12717 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12718 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12719 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012720 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012721 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12722 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012723 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012724 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12725 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012726
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012727check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012728 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012729 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12730 for normal traffic.
12731
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012732ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012733 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12734 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12735 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012736 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12737 information and recommendations see e.g.
12738 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12739 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12740 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012741
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012742ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12743 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12744 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12745 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12746 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012747 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12748 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12749 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012751cookie <value>
12752 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12753 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12754 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12755 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12756 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12757 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12758 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12759
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012760crl-file <crlfile>
12761 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12762 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12763 to verify server's certificate.
12764
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012765crt <cert>
12766 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12767 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12768 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12769 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12770 certificate request.
12771
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012772disabled
12773 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12774 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12775 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12776 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12777 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012778 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012779
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012780enabled
12781 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12782 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12783 default value.
12784 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12785 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012787error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012788 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12789 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12790 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012792 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012794fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012795 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12796 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12797 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12798
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012799force-sslv3
12800 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12801 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012802 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012803 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012804
12805force-tlsv10
12806 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012807 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012808 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012809
12810force-tlsv11
12811 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012812 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012813 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012814
12815force-tlsv12
12816 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012817 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012818 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012819
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012820force-tlsv13
12821 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12822 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012823 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012825id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012826 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12827 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12828 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012829
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012830init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12831 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12832 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012833 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012834 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12835 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12836 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12837 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12838 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12839 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12840 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12841 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12842 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012843 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012844 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12845 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12846 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12847 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12848 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12849 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012850 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012851
12852 Example:
12853 defaults
12854 # never fail on address resolution
12855 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012857inter <delay>
12858fastinter <delay>
12859downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012860 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12861 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12862 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12863 between checks depending on the server state :
12864
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012865 Server state | Interval used
12866 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12867 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12868 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12869 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12870 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12871 or yet unchecked. |
12872 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12873 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12874 | "inter" otherwise.
12875 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012877 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12878 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12879 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12880 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012881 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12882 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12883 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12884 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12885 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012887maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012888 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12889 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012890 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12891 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012892 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12893 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12894 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12895 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12896
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012897 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12898 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12899 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12900 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12901 than 50 concurrent requests.
12902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012903maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012904 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12905 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12906 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12907 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12908 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12909 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12910 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12911
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012912max-reuse <count>
12913 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12914 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12915 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12916 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12917 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12918 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12919 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12920 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12921
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012922minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012923 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12924 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12925 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12926 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12927 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12928 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012929 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012930 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012931
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012932namespace <name>
12933 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12934 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12935 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12936 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12937
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012938no-agent-check
12939 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12940 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12941 default value.
12942 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12943 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12944
12945no-backup
12946 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12947 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12948 default value.
12949 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12950 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12951
12952no-check
12953 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12954 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12955 default value.
12956 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12957 "default-server" "check" setting.
12958
12959no-check-ssl
12960 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12961 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12962 default value.
12963 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12964 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12965
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012966no-send-proxy
12967 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12968 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12969 default value.
12970 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12971 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12972
12973no-send-proxy-v2
12974 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12975 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12976 default value.
12977 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12978 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12979
12980no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12981 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12982 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12983 default value.
12984 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12985 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12986
12987no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12988 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12989 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12990 default value.
12991 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12992 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12993
12994no-ssl
12995 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12996 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12997 default value.
12998 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12999 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13000
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013001no-ssl-reuse
13002 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13003 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13004 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13005 and for paranoid users.
13006
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013007no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013008 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13009 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013010 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013011
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013012 Supported in default-server: No
13013
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013014no-tls-tickets
13015 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13016 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13017 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013018 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13019 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013020 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13021 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13022 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013023 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013024
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013025no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013026 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013027 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13028 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013029 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13030 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013031 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013032
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013033 Supported in default-server: No
13034
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013035no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013036 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013037 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13038 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013039 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13040 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013041 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013042
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013043 Supported in default-server: No
13044
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013045no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013046 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013047 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13048 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013049 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13050 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013051 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013052
13053 Supported in default-server: No
13054
13055no-tlsv13
13056 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13057 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13058 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13059 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13060 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013061 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013062
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013063 Supported in default-server: No
13064
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013065no-verifyhost
13066 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13067 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13068 default value.
13069 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13070 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013071
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013072no-tfo
13073 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13074 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13075 default value.
13076 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13077 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13078
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013079non-stick
13080 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13081 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13082 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13083
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013084npn <protocols>
13085 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13086 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13087 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013088 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013089 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13090 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13091 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013093observe <mode>
13094 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13095 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13096 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13097 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13098 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13099 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013100 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013101
13102 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13103
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013104on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013105 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13106 Currently, four modes are available:
13107 - fastinter: force fastinter
13108 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13109 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13110 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13111 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13112
13113 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13114
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013115on-marked-down <action>
13116 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13117 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013118 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13119 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13120 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13121 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13122 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13123 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13124 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13125 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013126
13127 Actions are disabled by default
13128
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013129on-marked-up <action>
13130 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13131 Currently one action is available:
13132 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13133 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13134 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13135 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013136 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13137 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013138 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13139 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13140
13141 Actions are disabled by default
13142
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013143pool-max-conn <max>
13144 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13145 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13146 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13147 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13148 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13149 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13150
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013151pool-purge-delay <delay>
13152 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013153 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013154 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013156port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013157 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13158 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13159 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13160 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13161 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13162 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13163
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013164proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013165 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13166 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13167 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13168 reported in haproxy -vv.
13169 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
13170 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013172redir <prefix>
13173 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13174 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13175 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13176 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13177 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13178 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13179 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13180 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013181 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013182 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013183 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13184 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13185 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13186 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13187
13188 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13189
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013190rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013191 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13192 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13193 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13194
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013195resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13196 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13197 server.
13198
13199 Available options:
13200
13201 * allow-dup-ip
13202 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13203 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13204 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13205 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13206 For such case, simply enable this option.
13207 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13208
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013209 * ignore-weight
13210 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13211 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13212 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13213
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013214 * prevent-dup-ip
13215 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13216 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13217 same fqdn.
13218 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13219
13220 Example:
13221 backend b_myapp
13222 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13223 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13224 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13225
13226 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13227 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13228 it
13229 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13230 different address
13231
13232 Default value: not set
13233
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013234resolve-prefer <family>
13235 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13236 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13237 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13238 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13239
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013240 Default value: ipv6
13241
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013242 Example:
13243
13244 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013245
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013246resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013247 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013248 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013249 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013250 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13251 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013252 configured network, another address is selected.
13253
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013254 Example:
13255
13256 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013257
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013258resolvers <id>
13259 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13260 hostname.
13261
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013262 Example:
13263
13264 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013265
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013266 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013267
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013268send-proxy
13269 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13270 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13271 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13272 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013273 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13274 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13275 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13276 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13277 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13278 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13279 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13280 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13281 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13282 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013283 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13284 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013285
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013286send-proxy-v2
13287 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13288 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13289 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13290 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013291 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13292 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13293 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13294 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013295
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013296proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013297 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13298 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13299
13300 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13301 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13302 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13303 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13304 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13305 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13306 connection is supported).
13307 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13308 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13309 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13310 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13311 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13312 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13313 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013314
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013315send-proxy-v2-ssl
13316 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13317 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13318 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13319 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13320 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13321 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13322 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013323 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13324 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013325
13326send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13327 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13328 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13329 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13330 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13331 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13332 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13333 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13334 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013335 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13336 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013338slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013339 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13340 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13341 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13342 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13343 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13344 parameters :
13345
13346 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13347 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13348
13349 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13350 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13351 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13352 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13353
13354 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13355 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13356 seen as failed.
13357
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013358sni <expression>
13359 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13360 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13361 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13362 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013363 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13364 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013365 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013366 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13367 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013368
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013369source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013370source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013371source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013372 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13373 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13374 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13375 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13376
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013377 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13378 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13379 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13380 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13381 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13382 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13383 server.
13384
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013385 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13386 specifying the source address without port(s).
13387
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013388ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013389 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13390 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13391 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13392 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13393 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13394 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013395 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13396 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013397
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013398ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13399 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13400 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13401 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13402
13403ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13404 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13405 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13406 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13407
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013408ssl-reuse
13409 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13410 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13411 default value.
13412 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13413 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13414
13415stick
13416 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13417 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13418 default value.
13419 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13420 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013421
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013422socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013423 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013424 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13425 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13426
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013427tcp-ut <delay>
13428 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13429 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13430 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013431 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013432 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13433 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13434 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13435 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13436 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13437 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13438 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13439 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13440 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13441
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013442tfo
13443 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13444 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13445 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13446 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13447 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013448 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013450track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013451 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13452 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13453 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13454 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013455 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13456
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013457tls-tickets
13458 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13459 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13460 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013461 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13462 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13463 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013464 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013465 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013466
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013467verify [none|required]
13468 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013469 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013470 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13471 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013472 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013473 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13474 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13475 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13476 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13477 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13478 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13479 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13480 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013481
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013482verifyhost <hostname>
13483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013484 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13485 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13486 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13487 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13488 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13489 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13490 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13491 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013492
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013493weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013494 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13495 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13496 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013497 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13498 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13499 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13500 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13501 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13502 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013503
13504
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200135055.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13506-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013507
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013508HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13509using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13510configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013511This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13512can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13513workload.
13514This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13515resolution at run time.
13516Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13517carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13518
13519
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200135205.3.1. Global overview
13521----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013522
13523As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13524different steps of the process life:
13525
13526 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13527 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13528 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13529
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013530 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13531 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013532
13533A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13534 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13535 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13536 resolution to know this new IP.
13537
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013538When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013539HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013540SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13541from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13542will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13543will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013544
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013545A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013546 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013547 first valid response.
13548
13549 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13550 servers return an error.
13551
13552
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200135535.3.2. The resolvers section
13554----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013555
13556This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013557HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13558contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013559
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013560When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13561uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13562is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13563answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13564
13565When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013566used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013567
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013568 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13569 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13570 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013571
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013572 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13573 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013574
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013575 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13576 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13577 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013578
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013579For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13580following scenarios are possible:
13581
13582 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13583 ignored
13584
13585 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13586 applied
13587
13588 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13589 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13590
13591 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13592 retries the query with a new type
13593
13594 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13595 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013596
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013597As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13598a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013599<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013600
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013601
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013602resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013603 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013604
13605A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13606
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013607accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013608 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013609 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013610 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13611 by RFC 6891)
13612
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013613 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13614
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013615nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13616 DNS server description:
13617 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13618 <ip> : IP address of the server
13619 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13620
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013621parse-resolv-conf
13622 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13623 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13624 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13625
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013626hold <status> <period>
13627 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13628 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013629 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013630 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013631 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13632 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13633 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13634
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013635 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013636
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013637resolve_retries <nb>
13638 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13639 giving up.
13640 Default value: 3
13641
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013642 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13643 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13644 type.
13645
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013646timeout <event> <time>
13647 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13648 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13649 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013650 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13651 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013652 Default value: 1s
13653 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013654 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013655 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013656 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13657 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13658
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013659 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013660
13661 resolvers mydns
13662 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13663 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013664 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013665 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013666 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013667 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013668 hold other 30s
13669 hold refused 30s
13670 hold nx 30s
13671 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013672 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013673 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013674
13675
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200136766. Cache
13677---------
13678
13679HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13680(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13681RAM.
13682
13683The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13684this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13685
13686If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13687independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13688when we try to allocate a new one.
13689
13690The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13691
13692It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13693"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13694for more details.
13695
13696When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13697replaced by "<CACHE>".
13698
13699
137006.1. Limitation
13701----------------
13702
13703The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13704
13705- If the response is not a 200
13706- If the response contains a Vary header
13707- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13708- If the response is not cacheable
13709
13710- If the request is not a GET
13711- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13712- If the request contains an Authorization header
13713
13714
137156.2. Setup
13716-----------
13717
13718To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13719the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13720
13721
137226.2.1. Cache section
13723---------------------
13724
13725cache <name>
13726 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13727 size of cache is mandatory.
13728
13729total-max-size <megabytes>
13730 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13731 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13732
13733max-object-size <bytes>
13734 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13735 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13736 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13737
13738max-age <seconds>
13739 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13740 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13741 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13742 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13743 default.
13744
13745
137466.2.2. Proxy section
13747---------------------
13748
13749http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13750 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13751 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13752 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13753 after this one.
13754
13755http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13756 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13757 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13758 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13759 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13760
13761
13762Example:
13763
13764 backend bck1
13765 mode http
13766
13767 http-request cache-use foobar
13768 http-response cache-store foobar
13769 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13770
13771 cache foobar
13772 total-max-size 4
13773 max-age 240
13774
13775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200137767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13777----------------------------------
13778
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013779HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013780client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13781The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13782these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13783but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13784data called patterns.
13785
13786
137877.1. ACL basics
13788---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013789
13790The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13791content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13792from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13793simple :
13794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013795 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013796 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013797 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13798 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013800The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13801adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013802
13803In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013805 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013806
13807This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13808Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13809and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013810an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13811conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13812as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13813are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013814
13815ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13816'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13817which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13818
13819There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13820performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013822The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13823specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13824this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013825methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13826ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013827
13828Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13829 - boolean
13830 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13831 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13832 - string
13833 - data block
13834
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013835Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13836converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13837would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13838The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13839which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13840
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013841Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13842keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13843fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13844which are summarized in the table below :
13845
13846 +---------------------+-----------------+
13847 | Sample or converter | Default |
13848 | output type | matching method |
13849 +---------------------+-----------------+
13850 | boolean | bool |
13851 +---------------------+-----------------+
13852 | integer | int |
13853 +---------------------+-----------------+
13854 | ip | ip |
13855 +---------------------+-----------------+
13856 | string | str |
13857 +---------------------+-----------------+
13858 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13859 +---------------------+-----------------+
13860
13861Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13862matching method, see below.
13863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013864The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13865 - boolean
13866 - integer or integer range
13867 - IP address / network
13868 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13869 - regular expression
13870 - hex block
13871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013872The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13873
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013874 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13875 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013876 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013877 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013878 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013879 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013880 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013882The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13883read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13884if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13885lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13886will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13887beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13888a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13889lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13890exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13891
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013892The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13893parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13894ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13895a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13896check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13897
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013898The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13899socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13900file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013902Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13903loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13904
13905 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13906
13907In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13908the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13909case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13910as well.
13911
13912The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13913sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13914do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13915methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13916is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013917obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013918followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13919default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13920that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13921string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13922
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013923The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13924By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13925string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13926resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13927server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013928waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013929flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13930function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013932There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13933sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13934be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013935
13936 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13937 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013938 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13939 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13940 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13941 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013942
13943 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13944 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013945 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013946
13947 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013948 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013949
13950 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013951 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013952
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013953 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013954 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13955
13956 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13957 binary or string samples.
13958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013959 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13960 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013962 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13963 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13964 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013966 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13967 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013969 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13970 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013972 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13973 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013975 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13976 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013977 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013979 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13980 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13981 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013982
13983For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13984request, it is possible to do :
13985
13986 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13987
13988In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13989buffer, one would use the following acl :
13990
13991 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13992
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013993On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13994possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13995
13996 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013998All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13999criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14000method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14001to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14002criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14003the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014005If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014006the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14007For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014009 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14010 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14011 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14012 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014013
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014014
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014015The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14016types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14017combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14018brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14019default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014021 +-------------------------------------------------+
14022 | Input sample type |
14023 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014024 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014025 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14026 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14027 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014028 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014029 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014030 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014031 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014032 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014033 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014034 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014035 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014036 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014037 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014038 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014039 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014040 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014041 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014042 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014043 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014044 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014046 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014047 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014048 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014049 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14050 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14051 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014052
14053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140547.1.1. Matching booleans
14055------------------------
14056
14057In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14058Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14059When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14060that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14061
14062Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14063return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14064"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14065
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140677.1.2. Matching integers
14068------------------------
14069
14070Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14071enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14072to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14073
14074Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14075matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14076lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014077
14078For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14079unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14080representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14081
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014082As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14083two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14084instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14085ranges and operators.
14086
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014087For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014088operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14089Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14090of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014091
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014092Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014093
14094 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14095 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14096 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14097 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14098 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14099
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014100For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014101
14102 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14103
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014104This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14105
14106 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14107
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200141097.1.3. Matching strings
14110-----------------------
14111
14112String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14113different forms :
14114
14115 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014116 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014117
14118 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014119 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014120
14121 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14122 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14123
14124 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14125 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14126
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014127 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014128 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14129 matches.
14130
14131 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14132 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14133 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014134
14135String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14136exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14137characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14138string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14139to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014140before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014141
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014142Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14143(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14144Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14145
14146Example:
14147 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14148 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14149
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200141517.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14152---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014153
14154Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14155they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14156possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14157passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14158the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014159the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14160match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014161
14162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200141637.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14164-------------------------------------
14165
14166It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14167not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14168a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14169to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14170digits may be used upper or lower case.
14171
14172Example :
14173 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14174 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14175
14176
141777.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14178---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014179
14180IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14181netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14182within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014183host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014184difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14185at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14186does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14187parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014188
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014189The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14190abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14191
14192 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14193 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14194 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14195 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14196 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14197 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14198 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14199 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14200
14201Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14202192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14203
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014204IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14205Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14206trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14207IPv6 patterns.
14208
14209HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14210following situations :
14211 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14212 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14213 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14214 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14215 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14216 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14217 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14218 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14219 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14220 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014222
142237.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14224----------------------------------
14225
14226Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14227combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14228
14229 - AND (implicit)
14230 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14231 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014233A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014235 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014237Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14238indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014240For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14241"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14242requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14243is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14244
14245 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014246 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14247 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14248 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014249
14250To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14251and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14252
14253 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14254 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14255 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14256 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14257
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014258 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014259 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14260 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14261 use_backend www if host_www
14262
14263It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14264expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14265be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14266the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14267
14268 The following rule :
14269
14270 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014271 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272
14273 Can also be written that way :
14274
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014275 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014276
14277It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14278to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14279simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14280sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14281good use is the following :
14282
14283 With named ACLs :
14284
14285 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14286 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14287 monitor fail if site_dead
14288
14289 With anonymous ACLs :
14290
14291 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14292
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014293See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14294keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014295
14296
142977.3. Fetching samples
14298---------------------
14299
14300Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14301against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14302sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14303ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14304of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14305available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14306
14307This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14308Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14309compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14310deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14311
14312The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14313matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14314method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14315indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14316
14317As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14318when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14319mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14320the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14321ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14322
14323Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14324multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14325when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014326incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14327are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14329all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14330
14331Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14332 - name
14333 - name(arg1)
14334 - name(arg1,arg2)
14335
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014336
143377.3.1. Converters
14338-----------------
14339
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014340Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14341of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14342is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14343was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014344has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014345unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14346
14347These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14348sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14349the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014350support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014351
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014352A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14353support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14354supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14355(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14356bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014358The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014359
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001436051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14361 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14362 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14363 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14364 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14365 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14366
14367 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014368 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14369 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014370 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14371 frontend http-in
14372 bind *:8081
14373 default_backend servers
14374 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14375 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14376
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014377add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014378 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014379 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014380 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14381 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014382 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014383 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14384 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14385 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14386 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014387 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014388 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014389
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014390aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14391 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14392 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14393 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14394 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14395 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14396 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14397
14398 Example:
14399 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14400 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14401
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014402and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014403 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014404 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014405 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14406 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014407 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014408 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14409 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14410 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14411 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014412 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014413 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014414
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014415b64dec
14416 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14417 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14418
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014419base64
14420 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014421 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014422 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14423
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014424bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014425 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014426 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014427 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014428 presence of a flag).
14429
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014430bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14431 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14432 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014433 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014434
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014435concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14436 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14437 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14438 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14439 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14440 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14441 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14442 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14443 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14444 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14445 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014446 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14447 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14448 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14449 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014450
14451 Example:
14452 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14453 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14454 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014455 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014456 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14457
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014458cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014459 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14460 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014461
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014462crc32([<avalanche>])
14463 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14464 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14465 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14466 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14467 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14468 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14469 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14470 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14471 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14472 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014473 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14474
14475crc32c([<avalanche>])
14476 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14477 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14478 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14479 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14480 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14481 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14482 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14483 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014484
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014485cut_crlf
14486 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14487 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14488 updated.
14489
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014490da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014491 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14492 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14493 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14494 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014495 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014496 configuration language.
14497
14498 Example:
14499 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014500 bind *:8881
14501 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014502 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014503
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014504debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14505 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14506 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14507 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14508 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14509 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14510 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14511 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14512 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14513 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14514 printable sample types.
14515
14516 Example:
14517 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014518
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014519digest(<algorithm>)
14520 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
14521 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
14522
14523 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14524 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14525
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014526div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014527 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14528 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014529 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014530 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14531 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014532 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014533 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14534 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14535 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14536 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014537 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014538 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014539
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014540djb2([<avalanche>])
14541 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14542 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14543 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14544 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14545 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14546 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14547 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014548 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14549 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014550
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014551even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014552 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014553 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14554
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014555field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14556 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14557 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14558 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14559 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14560 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14561 fields.
14562
14563 Example :
14564 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14565 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14566 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14567 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14568 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014569
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014570hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014571 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014572 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014573 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014574 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014575
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014576hex2i
14577 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014578 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014579
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014580htonl
14581 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14582 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14583 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14584 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14585
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014586hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
14587 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
14588 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
14589 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
14590 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
14591
14592 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14593 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14594
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014595http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014596 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14597 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014598 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14599 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14600 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14601 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14602 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14603 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14604 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14605 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014606
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014607in_table(<table>)
14608 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14609 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14610 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014611 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014612 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14613
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014614ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14615 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014616 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014617 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14618 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14619 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14620 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14621 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014622
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014623json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014624 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014625 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014626 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014627 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14628 of errors:
14629 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14630 bytes, ...)
14631 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14632 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14633
14634 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14635 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14636 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14637 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14638 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14639 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014640 - "ascii" : never fails;
14641 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14642 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014643 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014644 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014645 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14646 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14647
14648 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014649 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014650
14651 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014652 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014653 capture request header user-agent len 150
14654 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014655
14656 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14657 GET / HTTP/1.0
14658 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14659
14660 Output log:
14661 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14662
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014663language(<value>[,<default>])
14664 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14665 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14666 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14667 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14668 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14669 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14670 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14671 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14672 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014673 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014674 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14675 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014676
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014677 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014678
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014679 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14680 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014681
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014682 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14683 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14684 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14685 use_backend spanish if es
14686 use_backend french if fr
14687 use_backend english if en
14688 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014689
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014690length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014691 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14692 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14693 type. The result is of type integer.
14694
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014695lower
14696 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14697 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14698 type. The result is of type string.
14699
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014700ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14701 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14702 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14703 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14704 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14705 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14706 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14707
14708 Example :
14709
14710 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014711 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014712 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14713
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014714ltrim(<chars>)
14715 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14716 representation of the input sample.
14717
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014718map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14719map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14720map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14721 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14722 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14723 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14724 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14725 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14726 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14727 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14728 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014729
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014730 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14731 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14732 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014733
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014734 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014735 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014736
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014737 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14738 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14739 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14740 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014741 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14742 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014743 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14744 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14745 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14746 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14747 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14748 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14749 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14750 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014751 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14752 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14753 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014754 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14755 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14756 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14757 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14758 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014759
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014760 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14761 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14762 the corresponding match text.
14763
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014764 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14765 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14766 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14767 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14768 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014769
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014770 Example :
14771
14772 # this is a comment and is ignored
14773 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14774 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14775 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14776 | | | `---------- value
14777 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14778 | `---------------------------- key
14779 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14780
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014781mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014782 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14783 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014784 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014785 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014786 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014787 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14788 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14789 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14790 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014791 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014792 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014793
14794mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014795 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014796 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14797 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014798 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014799 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014800 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014801 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14802 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14803 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14804 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014805 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014806 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014807
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014808nbsrv
14809 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14810 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14811 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14812 map lookup.
14813
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014814neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014815 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14816 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14817 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14818 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014819
14820not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014821 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014822 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014823 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014824 absence of a flag).
14825
14826odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014827 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014828 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14829
14830or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014831 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014832 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014833 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14834 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014835 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014836 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14837 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14838 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14839 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014840 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014841 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014842
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014843protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14844 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14845 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14846 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14847 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14848 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14849 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14850 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14851 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14852 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14853 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14854 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14855
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014856regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014857 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14858 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14859 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14860 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14861 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14862 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14863 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14864 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14865 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014866 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14867 of characters with other ones.
14868
14869 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14870 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14871 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14872 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14873 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14874 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014875
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014876 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014877
14878 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14879 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14880 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014881 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014882
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014883 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14884 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14885
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014886 # capture groups and backreferences
14887 # both lines do the same.
14888 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14889 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14890
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014891capture-req(<id>)
14892 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14893 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14894
14895 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014896 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14897 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014898
14899capture-res(<id>)
14900 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14901 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14902
14903 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014904 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14905 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014906
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020014907rtrim(<chars>)
14908 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
14909 of the input sample.
14910
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014911sdbm([<avalanche>])
14912 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14913 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14914 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14915 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14916 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14917 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14918 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014919 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14920 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014921
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014922set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014923 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14924 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14925 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014926 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014927 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14928 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014929 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014930 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14931 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014932 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014933 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014934
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014935sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014936 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014937 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14938
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014939sha2([<bits>])
14940 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14941 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14942
14943 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14944 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14945
14946 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14947 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14948
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014949srv_queue
14950 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14951 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14952 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14953 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14954 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14955
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014956strcmp(<var>)
14957 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14958 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14959 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14960 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14961 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14962 shorter).
14963
14964 Example :
14965
14966 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14967 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14968 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14969
14970
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014971sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014972 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14973 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014974 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014975 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14976 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014977 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014978 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14979 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014980 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014981 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14982 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014983 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014984 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014985
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014986table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14987 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14988 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14989 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14990 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14991 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14992 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14993
14994
14995table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14996 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14997 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14998 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14999 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15000 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15001 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15002
15003table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15004 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15005 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015006 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015007 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15008 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15009
15010table_conn_cur(<table>)
15011 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15012 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15013 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15014 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15015 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15016
15017table_conn_rate(<table>)
15018 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15019 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15020 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15021 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15022 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15023
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015024table_gpt0(<table>)
15025 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15026 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15027 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15028 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15029 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15030
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015031table_gpc0(<table>)
15032 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15033 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15034 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15035 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15036 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15037
15038table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15039 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15040 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15041 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15042 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15043 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15044 sample fetch keyword.
15045
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015046table_gpc1(<table>)
15047 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15048 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15049 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15050 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15051 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15052
15053table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15054 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15055 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15056 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15057 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15058 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15059 sample fetch keyword.
15060
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015061table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15062 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15063 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015064 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015065 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15066 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15067
15068table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15069 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15070 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15071 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15072 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15073 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15074 keyword.
15075
15076table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15077 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15078 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015079 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015080 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15081 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15082
15083table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15084 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15085 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15086 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15087 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15088 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15089 keyword.
15090
15091table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15092 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15093 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015094 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015095 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15096 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15097 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15098 keyword.
15099
15100table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15101 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15102 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015103 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015104 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15105 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15106 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15107 keyword.
15108
15109table_server_id(<table>)
15110 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15111 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15112 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15113 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15114 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15115 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15116
15117table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15118 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15119 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015120 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015121 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15122 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15123 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15124 keyword.
15125
15126table_sess_rate(<table>)
15127 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15128 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15129 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15130 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15131 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15132 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15133 keyword.
15134
15135table_trackers(<table>)
15136 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15137 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15138 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15139 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15140 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15141 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15142 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15143 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15144 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15145 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15146
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015147upper
15148 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15149 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15150 type. The result is of type string.
15151
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015152url_dec([<in_form>])
15153 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15154 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15155 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15156 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15157 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15158 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015159
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015160ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015161 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015162 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15163 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15164 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015165 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15166 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15167 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15168 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015169 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015170 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15171 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015172
15173 Example:
15174 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15175 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15176
15177 message Point {
15178 int32 latitude = 1;
15179 int32 longitude = 2;
15180 }
15181
15182 message PPoint {
15183 Point point = 59;
15184 }
15185
15186 message Rectangle {
15187 // One corner of the rectangle.
15188 PPoint lo = 48;
15189 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15190 PPoint hi = 49;
15191 }
15192
15193 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15194 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15195 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
15196
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015197 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15198 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015199 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015200 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15201
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015202 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015203
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015204 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015205
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015206 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015207 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15208 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
15209
15210 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15211 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15212 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15213
15214 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15215 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15216 interpret the previous binary sample.
15217
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015218
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015219unset-var(<var name>)
15220 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15221 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15222 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15223 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15224 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15225 response),
15226 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15227 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15228 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15229 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15230
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015231utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15232 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15233 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15234 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15235 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15236 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15237 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15238
15239 Example :
15240
15241 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015242 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015243 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15244
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015245word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15246 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15247 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15248 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015249 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015250 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15251 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15252
15253 Example :
15254 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15255 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15256 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15257 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15258 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015259 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015260
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015261wt6([<avalanche>])
15262 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15263 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15264 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15265 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15266 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15267 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15268 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015269 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15270 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015271
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015272xor(<value>)
15273 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015274 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015275 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015276 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015277 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015278 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15279 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015280 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015281 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15282 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015283 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015284 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015285
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015286xxh32([<seed>])
15287 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15288 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15289 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15290 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15291 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15292 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15293 as cryptographically secure.
15294
15295xxh64([<seed>])
15296 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15297 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15298 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15299 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15300 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15301 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15302 as cryptographically secure.
15303
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015304
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153057.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015306--------------------------------------------
15307
15308A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15309not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15310"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15311The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15312
15313always_false : boolean
15314 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15315 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15316
15317always_true : boolean
15318 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15319 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15320
15321avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015322 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015323 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15324 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15325 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15326 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15327 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15328 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15329 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15330 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15331 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15332 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15333 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15334 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15335 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015337be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015338 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15339 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15340 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15341 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015342 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15343
15344be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15345 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15346 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15347 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15348 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15349 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015350 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15351 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015352
15353 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15354 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15355 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015357be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15358 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15359 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15360 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015361 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015362 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15363 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015364
15365 Example :
15366 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15367 backend dynamic
15368 mode http
15369 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15370 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015371
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015372bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015373 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15374 of the string.
15375
15376bool(<bool>) : bool
15377 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15378 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015380connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15381 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015382 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015383 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15384 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015385
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015386 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015387 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015388 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15389
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015390 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15391 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015392
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015393 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015394 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015395 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015396 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015397 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015398 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015399 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015400
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015401 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15402 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015403 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015404 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015405
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015406cpu_calls : integer
15407 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15408 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15409 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15410 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15411 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15412 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15413
15414cpu_ns_avg : integer
15415 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15416 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15417 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15418 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15419 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15420 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15421 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15422 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15423 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15424 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15425 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15426
15427cpu_ns_tot : integer
15428 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15429 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15430 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15431 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15432 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15433 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15434 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15435 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15436 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15437 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15438 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15439 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15440 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15441
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015442date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015443 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015444
15445 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15446 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15447 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015448 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15449
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015450 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15451 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15452 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15453 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15454 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15455
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015456 Example :
15457
15458 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15459 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015460
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015461 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15462 # millisecond granularity
15463 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15464
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015465date_us : integer
15466 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15467 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15468 from the same timeval structure.
15469
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015470distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15471 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15472 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15473 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15474 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15475 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15476 list of supported tokens.
15477
15478distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15479 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15480 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15481 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15482 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15483 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15484 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15485 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15486 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15487 supported tokens.
15488
15489 Example :
15490 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15491 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15492 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15493 # send large files to the big farm
15494 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15495
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015496env(<name>) : string
15497 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15498 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15499 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15500 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15501 certain way.
15502
15503 Examples :
15504 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15505 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15506
15507 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15508 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015510fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15511 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015512 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15513 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15515 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015516 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15518 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015519
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015520fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15521 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15522 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15523 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015525fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15526 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15527 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15528 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15529 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15530 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15531 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15532 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15533 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015534
15535 Example :
15536 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15537 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15538 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15539 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15540 frontend mail
15541 bind :25
15542 mode tcp
15543 maxconn 100
15544 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15545 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15546 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15547 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015548
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015549hostname : string
15550 Returns the system hostname.
15551
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015552int(<integer>) : signed integer
15553 Returns a signed integer.
15554
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015555ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15556 Returns an ipv4.
15557
15558ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15559 Returns an ipv6.
15560
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015561lat_ns_avg : integer
15562 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15563 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15564 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15565 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15566 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15567 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15568 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15569 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15570 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15571 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15572 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15573 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15574 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15575 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15576
15577lat_ns_tot : integer
15578 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15579 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15580 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15581 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15582 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15583 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15584 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15585 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15586 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15587 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15588 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15589 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15590 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15591 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15592 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15593 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15594 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15595 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15596 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15597
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015598meth(<method>) : method
15599 Returns a method.
15600
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015601nbproc : integer
15602 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15603 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15604 and debugging purposes.
15605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15607 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15608 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15609 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015610 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15611 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15612 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015613
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015614prio_class : integer
15615 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15616 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15617 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15618
15619prio_offset : integer
15620 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15621 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15622 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15623 set-priority-offset".
15624
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015625proc : integer
15626 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15627 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15628 debugging purposes.
15629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015631 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15632 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15633 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15635 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15636 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15637 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15638 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15639
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015640rand([<range>]) : integer
15641 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15642 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15643 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15644 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15645 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15646
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015647uuid([<version>]) : string
15648 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15649 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15650 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15653 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15654 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15655 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15656 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15657 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015658 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15659 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15660
15661srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15662 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15663 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15664 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15665 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15666 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15667 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15668 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15669
15670 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15671 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672
15673srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15674 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15675 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15676 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015677 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015678 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15679 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15680 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15681
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015682srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15683 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15684 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15685 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15686 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15687 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15688 fetch methods.
15689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15691 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15692 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015693 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15695 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015696 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697 overloading servers).
15698
15699 Example :
15700 # Redirect to a separate back
15701 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15702 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15703 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15704
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015705stopping : boolean
15706 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15707 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15708 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15709
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015710str(<string>) : string
15711 Returns a string.
15712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15714 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15715 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15716
15717table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15718 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15719 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15720 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15721
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015722thread : integer
15723 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15724 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15725 and debugging purposes.
15726
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015727var(<var-name>) : undefined
15728 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015729 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15730 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015731 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015732 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15733 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015734 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015735 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15736 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015737 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015738 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015739
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157407.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741----------------------------------
15742
15743The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15744closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15745methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15746sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15747TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015748the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15749counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015750"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15751used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15752can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15753Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15754table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15755tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15756currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015758bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015759 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15760 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15761 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763be_id : integer
15764 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020015765 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
15766 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015767
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015768be_name : string
15769 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020015770 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
15771 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015773dst : ip
15774 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15775 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15776 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15777 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015778 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15779 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15780 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15781 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15782 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15783 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015784
15785dst_conn : integer
15786 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15787 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15788 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15789 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15790 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15791 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15792 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15793 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015794
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015795dst_is_local : boolean
15796 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15797 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15798 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15799 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015800 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015801 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15802 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15803 it only once per connection.
15804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015805dst_port : integer
15806 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15807 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15808 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15809 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15810 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15811 an HTTP header.
15812
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015813fc_http_major : integer
15814 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15815 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15816 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15817
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015818fc_pp_authority : string
15819 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15820 if any.
15821
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015822fc_pp_unique_id : string
15823 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15824 if any.
15825
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015826fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15827 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15828 header.
15829
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015830fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15831 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15832 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15833 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15834 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15835 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15836 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15837
15838fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15839 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15840 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15841 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15842 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15843 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15844 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15845
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015846fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015847 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15848 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15849 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15850 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15851
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015852fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015853 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15854 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15855 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15856 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15857
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015858fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015859 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15860 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15861 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15862 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15863
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015864fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015865 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15866 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15867 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15868 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15869
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015870fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015871 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15872 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15873 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15874 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15875
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015876fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015877 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15878 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15879 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15880 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15881
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015882fe_defbe : string
15883 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15884 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886fe_id : integer
15887 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015888 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015889 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15890
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015891fe_name : string
15892 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15893 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15894 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15895
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015896sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015897sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15898sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15899sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015900 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15901 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15902 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015904sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015905sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15906sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15907sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015908 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15909 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15910 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15911
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015912sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015913sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15914sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15915sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015916 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15917 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015918 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15919 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15920 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015921
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015922 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015923 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15924 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015925 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15926 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15927 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015928 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15929 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15930
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015931sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15932sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15933sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15934sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15935 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15936 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15937 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15938 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15939 when a first ACL was verified.
15940
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015941sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015942sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15943sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15944sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015945 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015946 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15947
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015948sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015949sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15950sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15951sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015952 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15953 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15954 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15955
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015956sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015957sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15958sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15959sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015960 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15961 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15962 See also src_conn_rate.
15963
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015964sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015965sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15966sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15967sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015968 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015969 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015970
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015971sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15972sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15973sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15974sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15975 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15976 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15977
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015978sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15979sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15980sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15981sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15982 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15983 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15984
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015985sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015986sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15987sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15988sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015989 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15990 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15991 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015992 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15993 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15994 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015995
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015996sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15997sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15998sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15999sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16000 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16001 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16002 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16003 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16004 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16005 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16006
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016007sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016008sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16009sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16010sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016011 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016012 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16013 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16014
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016015sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016016sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16017sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16018sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016019 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16020 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16021 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16022 src_http_err_rate.
16023
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016024sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016025sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16026sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16027sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016028 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016029 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16030 src_http_req_cnt.
16031
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016032sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016033sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16034sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16035sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016036 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16037 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16038 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16039 src_http_req_rate.
16040
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016041sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016042sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16043sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16044sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016045 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016046 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16047 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16048 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16049 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016050
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016051 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016052 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16053 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016054 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16055
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016056sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16057sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16058sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16059sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16060 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16061 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16062 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16063 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16064 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016066sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016067sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16068sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16069sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016070 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16071 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16072 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016074sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016075sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16076sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16077sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016078 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16079 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16080 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016081
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016082sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016083sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16084sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16085sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016086 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016087 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16088 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16089 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016090 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016091 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16092
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016093sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016094sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16095sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16096sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016097 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16098 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16099 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16100 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16101 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016102 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016104sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016105sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16106sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16107sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016108 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16109 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16110 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16111
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016112sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016113sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16114sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16115sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016116 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16117 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016118 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016119 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16120 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16122 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16123 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016125so_id : integer
16126 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16127 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16128 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016129
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016130so_name : string
16131 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16132 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16133 strings instead of integers.
16134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016135src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016136 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016137 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16138 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16139 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016140 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16141 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16142 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016143 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16144 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16145 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16146 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16147 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16148 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16149 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016150
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016151 Example:
16152 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16153 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16156 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16157 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16158 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016159 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016161src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16162 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16163 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016164 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016165 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016167src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16168 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16169 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16170 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16171 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16172 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16173 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016174
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016175 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016176 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16177 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16178 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16179 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016180 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016181 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16182 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16183
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016184src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16185 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16186 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16187 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16188 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16189 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16190 was verified.
16191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016193 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016194 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016195 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016196 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016198src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016199 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16201 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016202 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016204src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16205 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16206 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16207 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016208 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016211 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016212 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016213 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016214 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016215
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016216src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16217 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16218 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16219 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16220 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16221
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016222src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16223 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16224 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16225 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16226 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016229 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016230 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016231 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16232 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016233 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16234 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16235 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016236
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016237src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16238 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16239 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16240 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16241 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16242 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16243 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16244 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016246src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016247 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016248 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016249 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016250 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016251 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016253src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16254 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16255 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16256 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16257 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016258 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016260src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016261 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016262 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16263 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016264 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16267 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16268 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16269 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016270 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016271 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016273src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16274 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16275 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16276 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016277 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16279 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016280
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016281 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016282 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016283 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016284 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016285
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016286src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16287 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16288 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16289 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16290 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16291 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16292 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16293
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016294src_is_local : boolean
16295 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16296 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16297 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16298 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016299 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016300 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16301 once per connection.
16302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016303src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016304 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16305 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16306 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16307 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16308 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016310src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016311 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16312 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16313 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16314 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16315 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016317src_port : integer
16318 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16319 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16320 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16321 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016323src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016324 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016325 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16326 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16327 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016328 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016330src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16331 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16332 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16333 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16334 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016335 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016337src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16338 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16339 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16340 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16341 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16342 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16343 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16344 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16345 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016346
16347 Example :
16348 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16349 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16350 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16351 listen ssh
16352 bind :22
16353 mode tcp
16354 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016355 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016356 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016357 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016359srv_id : integer
16360 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16361 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016362 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016363
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016364srv_name : string
16365 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16366 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016367 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016368
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163697.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016370----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016372The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16373closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16374when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16375usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016376future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016377
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001637851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16379 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16380 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16381 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16382 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16383 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16384
16385 Example :
16386 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16387 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16388 # the request.
16389 frontend http-in
16390 bind *:8081
16391 default_backend servers
16392 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16393 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16394
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016395ssl_bc : boolean
16396 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16397 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016398 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16399 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016400
16401ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16402 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016403 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16404 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016405
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016406ssl_bc_alpn : string
16407 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16408 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016409 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016410 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16411 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16412 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16413 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16414 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016415 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16416 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016417
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016418ssl_bc_cipher : string
16419 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016420 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16421 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016422
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016423ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16424 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16425 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16426 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016427 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016428
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016429ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16430 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16431 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016432 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16433 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016434
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016435ssl_bc_npn : string
16436 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16437 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016438 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016439 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16440 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16441 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16442 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016443 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16444 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016445
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016446ssl_bc_protocol : string
16447 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016448 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16449 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016450
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016451ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016452 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016453 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016454 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16455 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016456
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016457ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16458 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16459 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16460 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016461 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016462
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016463ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16464 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16465 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016466 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16467 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016468
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016469ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16470 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16471 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16472 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016473 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016474
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016475ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16476 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016477 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16478 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016480ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16481 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16482 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16483 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16484 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16485 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016487ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16488 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16489 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16490 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16491 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016492
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016493ssl_c_der : binary
16494 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16495 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16496 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016498ssl_c_err : integer
16499 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16500 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16501 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16502 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16503 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016504
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016505ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016506 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16507 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16508 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16509 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16510 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16511 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16512 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16513 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016514 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16515 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16516 LDAP v3.
16517 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16518 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016520ssl_c_key_alg : string
16521 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16522 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16523 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016525ssl_c_notafter : string
16526 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16527 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16528 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016530ssl_c_notbefore : string
16531 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16532 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16533 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016534
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016535ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016536 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16537 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16538 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16539 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16540 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16541 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16542 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16543 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016544 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16545 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16546 LDAP v3.
16547 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16548 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016550ssl_c_serial : binary
16551 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16552 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16553 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016555ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16556 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16557 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16558 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016559 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16560 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16561
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016562 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016563 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016565ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16566 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16567 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16568 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016570ssl_c_used : boolean
16571 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16572 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016574ssl_c_verify : integer
16575 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16576 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16577 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16578 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016580ssl_c_version : integer
16581 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16582 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016583
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016584ssl_f_der : binary
16585 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16586 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16587 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16588
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016589ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016590 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16591 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16592 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16593 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016594 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016595 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16596 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16597 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016598 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16599 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16600 LDAP v3.
16601 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16602 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016604ssl_f_key_alg : string
16605 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16606 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16607 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016609ssl_f_notafter : string
16610 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16611 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16612 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016614ssl_f_notbefore : string
16615 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16616 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16617 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016618
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016619ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016620 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16621 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16622 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16623 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16624 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16625 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16626 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16627 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016628 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16629 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16630 LDAP v3.
16631 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16632 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016634ssl_f_serial : binary
16635 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16636 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16637 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016638
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016639ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16640 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16641 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16642 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016644ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16645 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16646 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16647 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016649ssl_f_version : integer
16650 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16651 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16652
16653ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016654 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16655 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16656 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016658 Example :
16659 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16660 listen http-https
16661 bind :80
16662 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16663 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16664
16665ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16666 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16667 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16668
16669ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016670 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016671 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16672 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16673 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16674 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16675 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16676 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16677 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16678 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016680ssl_fc_cipher : string
16681 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16682 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016683
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016684ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16685 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16686 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016687 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016688
16689ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16690 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16691 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016692 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016693
16694ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16695 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16696 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16697 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016698 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016699 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016700
16701ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16702 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16703 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016704 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016705
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016706ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16707 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16708 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16709 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016711ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016712 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16713 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016714 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16715 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16716 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16717 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016718
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016719ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16720 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16721 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16722 wait until the handshake happened.
16723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016724ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16725 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016726 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16727 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016728 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016729 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016730
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016731ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016732 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016733 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16734 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016736ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016737 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016738 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16739 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16740 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16741 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16742 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16743 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16744 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016746ssl_fc_protocol : string
16747 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16748 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016749
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016750ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016751 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016752 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16753 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016754
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016755ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16756 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16757 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16758 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016760ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16761 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16762 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16763 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16764 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016765
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016766ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16767 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16768 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16769 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16770 BoringSSL.
16771
16772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016773ssl_fc_sni : string
16774 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16775 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16776 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16777 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16778 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16779
16780 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16781 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16782 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016783 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016784 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016787 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16788 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016790ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16791 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16792 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016793
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016794
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200167957.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016796------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016798Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16799sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16800only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16801For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16802be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16803can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16804sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16805for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16806content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016808payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016809 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016810 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16811 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016813payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16814 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016815 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016816 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016817
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016818req.hdrs : string
16819 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16820 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16821 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16822 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16823
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016824req.hdrs_bin : binary
16825 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16826 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16827 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16828 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16829 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16830 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16831
16832 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16833
16834 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16835 str: <int:length><bytes>
16836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016837req.len : integer
16838req_len : integer (deprecated)
16839 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16840 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16841 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16842 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16843 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16844 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16845 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16846 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016848req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16849 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016850 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16851 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16852 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16853 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016855 ACL alternatives :
16856 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016858req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16859 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16860 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16861 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16862 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016864 ACL alternatives :
16865 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016867 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016869req.proto_http : boolean
16870req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16871 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16872 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16873 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16874 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16875 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16876 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16877 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016879 Example:
16880 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16881 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16882 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016883 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016885req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16886rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16887 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16888 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16889 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16890 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16891 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16892 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16893 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016895 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16896 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16897 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16898 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16899 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16900 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016902 ACL derivatives :
16903 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016905 Example :
16906 listen tse-farm
16907 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16908 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16909 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16910 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16911 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16912 persist rdp-cookie
16913 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16914 # This is only useful makes sense if
16915 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16916 stick-table type string size 204800
16917 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16918 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16919 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016921 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16922 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016924req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16925rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16926 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16927 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16928 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16929 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016931 ACL derivatives :
16932 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016933
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016934req.ssl_alpn : string
16935 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16936 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16937 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16938 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16939 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16940 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016941 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016942
16943 Examples :
16944 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16945 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16946 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016947 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016948 default_backend bk_default
16949
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016950req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16951 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16952 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016953 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16954 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16955 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16956 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16957 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016959req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16960req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16961 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16962 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16963 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16964 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16965 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16966 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16967 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016969req.ssl_sni : string
16970req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16971 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16972 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16973 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16974 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16975 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16976 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16977 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16978 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16979 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16980 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16981 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16982 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016984 ACL derivatives :
16985 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016987 Examples :
16988 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16989 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16990 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16991 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16992 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016993
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016994req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16995 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16996 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16997 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16998 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16999 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17000 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17001 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17002 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17003 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017005req.ssl_ver : integer
17006req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17007 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17008 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17009 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17010 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17011 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17012 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17013 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017014 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017015 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017017 ACL derivatives :
17018 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017019
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017020res.len : integer
17021 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17022 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17023 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17024 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17025 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17026 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17027 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017028 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017030res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17031 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017032 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017033 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017034 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017035 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017037res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17038 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17039 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17040 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017041 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17042 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017044 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017045
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017046res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17047rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17048 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17049 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17050 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17051 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17052 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17053 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17054 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017056wait_end : boolean
17057 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17058 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017059 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017060 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17061 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017062 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017063 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17064 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017066 Examples :
17067 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17068 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17069 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017071 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17072 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17073 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17074 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17075 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17076 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17077 tcp-request content reject
17078
17079
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170807.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017081--------------------------------------
17082
17083It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17084This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17085data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17086its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17087HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17088content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17089to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17090more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17091response are indexed.
17092
17093base : string
17094 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17095 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17096 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17097 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17098 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17099 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17100 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17101 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17102
17103 ACL derivatives :
17104 base : exact string match
17105 base_beg : prefix match
17106 base_dir : subdir match
17107 base_dom : domain match
17108 base_end : suffix match
17109 base_len : length match
17110 base_reg : regex match
17111 base_sub : substring match
17112
17113base32 : integer
17114 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17115 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17116 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017117 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17118 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17119 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017120
17121base32+src : binary
17122 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17123 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17124 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17125 per-URL counters.
17126
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017127capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17128 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17129 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17130 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17131
17132capture.req.method : string
17133 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17134 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17135 because it's allocated.
17136
17137capture.req.uri : string
17138 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17139 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17140 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17141 allocated.
17142
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017143capture.req.ver : string
17144 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17145 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17146 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17147
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017148capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17149 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17150 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17151 The first entry is an index of 0.
17152 See also: "capture response header"
17153
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017154capture.res.ver : string
17155 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17156 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17157 persistent flag.
17158
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017159req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017160 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17161 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17162 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017163
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017164req.body_param([<name>) : string
17165 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17166 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17167 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17168 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17169 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17170 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17171 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17172 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17173 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17174 given.
17175
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017176req.body_len : integer
17177 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17178 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017179 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17180 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017181
17182req.body_size : integer
17183 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017184 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17185 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017187req.cook([<name>]) : string
17188cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17189 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17190 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17191 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17192 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17193 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17194 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17195 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17196 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17197
17198 ACL derivatives :
17199 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17200 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17201 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17202 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17203 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17204 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17205 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17206 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017208req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17209cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17210 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17211 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017213req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17214cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17215 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17216 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17217 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17218 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017220cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17221 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17222 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17223 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17224 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017225 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017226 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17227 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17228 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17229 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017231hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17232 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17233 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17234 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17235 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017236 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017238req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17239 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17240 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17241 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17242 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17243 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17244 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17245 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17246 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017248req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17249 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17250 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17251 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17252 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017254req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17255 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17256 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17257 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17258 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17259 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17260 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17261 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17262 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017263 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017264 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017265 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017267 ACL derivatives :
17268 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17269 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17270 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17271 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17272 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17273 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17274 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17275 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17276
17277req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17278hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17279 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17280 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17281 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17282 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17283 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17284 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17285 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17286 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17287 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17288
17289req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17290hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17291 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17292 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17293 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17294 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17295 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017296 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017297 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17298 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17299
17300req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17301hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17302 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17303 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17304 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17305 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17306 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17307 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17308 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17309
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017310
17311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017312http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17313 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17314 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17315 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17316 basic auth is supported.
17317
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017318http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17319 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17320 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17321 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17322 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017323 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17324 basic auth is supported.
17325
17326 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017327 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17328 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17329 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17330 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017331
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017332http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017333 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17334 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17335 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017336
17337http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017338 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17339 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17340 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017341
17342http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017343 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17344 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17345 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017347http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017348 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17349 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017350 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17351 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017353method : integer + string
17354 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17355 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17356 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17357 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17358 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17359 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17360 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017362 ACL derivatives :
17363 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017365 Example :
17366 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17367 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17368 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017370path : string
17371 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17372 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17373 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17374 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17375 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017376 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017377 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017379 ACL derivatives :
17380 path : exact string match
17381 path_beg : prefix match
17382 path_dir : subdir match
17383 path_dom : domain match
17384 path_end : suffix match
17385 path_len : length match
17386 path_reg : regex match
17387 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017388
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017389query : string
17390 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17391 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17392 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17393 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017394 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017395 which stops before the question mark.
17396
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017397req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17398 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17399 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17400 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17401 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017403req.ver : string
17404req_ver : string (deprecated)
17405 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17406 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17407 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017409 ACL derivatives :
17410 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017411
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017412res.body : binary
17413 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
17414 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17415 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17416 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17417
17418res.body_len : integer
17419 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
17420 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17421 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17422 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17423
17424res.body_size : integer
17425 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
17426 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17427 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
17428 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
17429 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
17430 based expect rules.
17431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017432res.comp : boolean
17433 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17434 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17435 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017437res.comp_algo : string
17438 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17439 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17440 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017442res.cook([<name>]) : string
17443scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17444 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17445 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017446 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
17447 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017449 ACL derivatives :
17450 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017452res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17453scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17454 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17455 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017456 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
17457 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017459res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17460scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17461 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17462 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017463 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
17464 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017466res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17467 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17468 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17469 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17470 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17471 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17472 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17473 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17474 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017475 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017477res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17478 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17479 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17480 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17481 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017482 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
17483 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017485res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17486shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17487 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17488 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17489 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17490 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17491 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17492 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17493 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017494 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
17495 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017497 ACL derivatives :
17498 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17499 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17500 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17501 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17502 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17503 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17504 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17505 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17506
17507res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17508shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17509 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17510 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17511 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17512 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017513 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017515res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17516shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17517 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17518 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17519 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17520 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17521 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017522 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
17523 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017524
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017525res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17526 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17527 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17528 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017529 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
17530 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017532res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17533shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17534 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17535 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17536 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17537 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17538 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017539 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
17540 based expect rules.
17541
17542res.hdrs : string
17543 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
17544 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17545 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17546 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
17547 based expect rules.
17548
17549res.hdrs_bin : binary
17550 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17551 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
17552 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
17553 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
17554 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
17555 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
17556 (length of 0 for both).
17557
17558 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17559
17560 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17561 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017563res.ver : string
17564resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17565 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017566 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
17567 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017569 ACL derivatives :
17570 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017572set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17573 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17574 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017575 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017576 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017578 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17579 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017581status : integer
17582 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17583 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017584 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
17585 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017586
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017587unique-id : string
17588 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17589 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17590 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17591 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17592 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17593 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017595url : string
17596 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17597 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17598 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17599 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17600 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17601 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17602 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017604 ACL derivatives :
17605 url : exact string match
17606 url_beg : prefix match
17607 url_dir : subdir match
17608 url_dom : domain match
17609 url_end : suffix match
17610 url_len : length match
17611 url_reg : regex match
17612 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017614url_ip : ip
17615 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17616 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17617 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17618 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17619 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17620 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17621 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017623url_port : integer
17624 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17625 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17626 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17627 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017628
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017629urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17630url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017631 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17632 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017633 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17634 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17635 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17636 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017637 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17638 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017639 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17640 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017642 ACL derivatives :
17643 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17644 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17645 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17646 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17647 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17648 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17649 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17650 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017651
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017653 Example :
17654 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17655 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17656 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17657 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017658
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017659urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017660 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17661 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17662 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017663
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017664url32 : integer
17665 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17666 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17667 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17668 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17669 is an unsigned integer.
17670
17671url32+src : binary
17672 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17673 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17674 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17675
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020017676
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200176777.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017678---------------------------------------
17679
17680This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17681used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17682purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17683There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17684or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17685any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17686for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17687
17688internal.htx.data : integer
17689 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17690 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17691
17692internal.htx.free : integer
17693 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17694 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17695
17696internal.htx.free_data : integer
17697 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17698 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17699
17700internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17701 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17702 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17703 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17704
17705internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17706 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17707 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17708
17709internal.htx.size : integer
17710 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17711 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17712
17713internal.htx.used : integer
17714 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17715 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17716 direction.
17717
17718internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17719 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17720 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17721 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17722 of the special value :
17723 * head : The oldest inserted block
17724 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017725 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017726
17727internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17728 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17729 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17730 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17731 integer or one of the special value :
17732 * head : The oldest inserted block
17733 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017734 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017735
17736internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17737 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17738 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17739 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17740 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17741
17742 * head : The oldest inserted block
17743 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017744 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017745
17746internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17747 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17748 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17749 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17750 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17751
17752 * head : The oldest inserted block
17753 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017754 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017755
17756internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17757 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17758 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17759 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17760 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17761
17762 * head : The oldest inserted block
17763 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017764 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017765
17766internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17767 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17768 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17769 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17770 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17771
17772 * head : The oldest inserted block
17773 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017774 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017775
17776internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17777 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17778 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17779 it returns false.
17780
17781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200177827.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017783---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017785Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17786every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017787order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017789ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17790---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017791FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017792HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017793HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17794HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017795HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17796HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17797HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17798HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17799LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017800METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017801METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017802METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17803METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17804METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17805METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017806METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017807METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017808RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017809REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017810TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017811WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17812---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017813
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178158. Logging
17816----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017817
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017818One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17819provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17820very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17821provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17822state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017823to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017824headers.
17825
17826In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17827about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17828send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17829
17830 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17831 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17832 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17833 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17834 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017835 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017836 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017837
17838The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17839allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17840as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17841while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17842real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17843delay.
17844
17845
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178468.1. Log levels
17847---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017848
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017849TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017850source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017851HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17852in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17853track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17854syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17855about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017856
17857
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178588.2. Log formats
17859----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017860
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017861HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017862and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17863slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17864options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017865
17866 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17867 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17868 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17869 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17870 extents.
17871
17872 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17873 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17874 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17875 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17876 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17877
17878 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17879 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17880 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17881 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17882 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17883
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017884 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17885 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17886 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17887 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17888
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017889 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17890
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017891Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17892specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17893field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17894servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17895always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17896identifier.
17897
17898Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17899 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17900 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17901 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17902 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17903
17904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179058.2.1. Default log format
17906-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017907
17908This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17909as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17910format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17911
17912 Example :
17913 listen www
17914 mode http
17915 log global
17916 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17917
17918 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17919 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17920 (www/HTTP)
17921
17922 Field Format Extract from the example above
17923 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17924 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17925 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17926 4 'to' to
17927 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17928 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17929
17930Detailed fields description :
17931 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17932 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17933 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17934 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17935 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17936 and processed the connection.
17937 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17938
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017939In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17940"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17941connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17942
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017943It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17944will eventually disappear.
17945
17946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179478.2.2. TCP log format
17948---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017949
17950The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17951is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17952information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17953counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17954emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17955environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17956the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17957sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017958specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17959not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17960fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17961marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017962
17963 Example :
17964 frontend fnt
17965 mode tcp
17966 option tcplog
17967 log global
17968 default_backend bck
17969
17970 backend bck
17971 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17972
17973 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17974 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17975 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17976
17977 Field Format Extract from the example above
17978 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17979 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17980 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17981 4 frontend_name fnt
17982 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17983 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17984 7 bytes_read* 212
17985 8 termination_state --
17986 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17987 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17988
17989Detailed fields description :
17990 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017991 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17992 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17993 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017994 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017995 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017996 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017997
17998 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017999 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18000 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18001 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018002
18003 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18004 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18005 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018006 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18007 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18008 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18009 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018010
18011 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18012 and processed the connection.
18013
18014 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18015 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18016 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18017 applications.
18018
18019 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18020 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18021 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18022 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18023 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18024
18025 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18026 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18027 See "Timers" below for more details.
18028
18029 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18030 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18031 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18032 "Timers" below for more details.
18033
18034 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018035 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018036 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18037 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18038 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18039 details.
18040
18041 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18042 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18043 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18044 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18045 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18046
18047 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18048 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18049 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18050 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18051 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18052 for more details.
18053
18054 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018055 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018056 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18057 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18058 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018059 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018060
18061 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18062 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18063 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18064 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18065 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18066 caused by a denial of service attack.
18067
18068 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18069 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18070 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18071 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18072 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18073 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18074 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18075 denial of service attack.
18076
18077 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18078 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18079 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18080 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18081 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18082 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18083 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18084 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18085 be processed than on other servers.
18086
18087 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18088 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18089 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18090 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18091 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18092 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18093 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18094 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18095 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18096 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18097 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18098 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18099 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18100
18101 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18102 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18103 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18104 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18105 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18106 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018107 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018108 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18109
18110 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18111 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18112 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18113 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18114 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18115 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018116 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018117 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18118 occurs.
18119
18120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181218.2.3. HTTP log format
18122----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018123
18124The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18125is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18126the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18127are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18128emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18129generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18130"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18131which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018132frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18133is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018134
18135Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18136slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18137with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18138
18139 Example :
18140 frontend http-in
18141 mode http
18142 option httplog
18143 log global
18144 default_backend bck
18145
18146 backend static
18147 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18148
18149 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18150 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18151 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018152 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018153
18154 Field Format Extract from the example above
18155 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18156 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018157 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018158 4 frontend_name http-in
18159 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018160 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018161 7 status_code 200
18162 8 bytes_read* 2750
18163 9 captured_request_cookie -
18164 10 captured_response_cookie -
18165 11 termination_state ----
18166 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18167 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18168 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18169 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18170 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018171
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018172Detailed fields description :
18173 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018174 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18175 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18176 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018177 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018178 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018179 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018180
18181 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018182 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18183 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18184 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018185
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018186 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18187 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018188
18189 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18190 and processed the connection.
18191
18192 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18193 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18194 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18195
18196 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18197 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18198 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18199 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18200 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18201 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18202
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018203 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18204 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18205 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018206 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018207 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18208 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018209 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18210 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018211
18212 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18213 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018214 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018215
18216 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18217 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018218 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18219 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018220
18221 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18222 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18223 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18224 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18225 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018226 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18227 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018228
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018229 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18230 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18231 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18232 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18233 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18234 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18235 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018236 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018237
18238 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18239 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18240 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18241
18242 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18243 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018244 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018245 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18246 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18247 overflowing.
18248
18249 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18250 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18251 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18252 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18253 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18254 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18255 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18256 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18257
18258 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18259 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18260 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18261 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18262 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18263 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18264 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18265 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18266
18267 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18268 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18269 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18270 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18271 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18272 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18273 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18274
18275 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018276 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018277 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18278 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18279 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018280 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018281 system.
18282
18283 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18284 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18285 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18286 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18287 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18288 caused by a denial of service attack.
18289
18290 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18291 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18292 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18293 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18294 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18295 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18296 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18297 denial of service attack.
18298
18299 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18300 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18301 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18302 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18303 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18304 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18305 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18306 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18307 processed than on other servers.
18308
18309 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18310 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18311 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18312 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18313 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18314 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18315 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18316 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18317 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18318 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18319 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18320 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18321 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18322
18323 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18324 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18325 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18326 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18327 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18328 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018329 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018330 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18331
18332 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18333 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18334 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18335 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18336 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18337 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018338 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018339 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18340 occurs.
18341
18342 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18343 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18344 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18345 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18346 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18347 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18348 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18349 cookies" below for more details.
18350
18351 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18352 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18353 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18354 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18355 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18356 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18357 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18358 and cookies" below for more details.
18359
18360 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18361 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18362 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18363 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18364 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18365 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18366 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18367 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18368
18369
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200183708.2.4. Custom log format
18371------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018372
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018373The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018374mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018375
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018376HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018377Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18378separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18379prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18380
18381Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18382variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018383("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018384
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018385If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018386as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018387less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18388the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18389
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018390Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018391In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018392in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018393
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018394Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18395'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18396https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18397such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18398
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018399Flags are :
18400 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018401 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018402 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18403 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018404
18405 Example:
18406
18407 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18408 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18409
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018410 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18411
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018412At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18413
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018414 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18415 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018416
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018417the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018418
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018419 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18420 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18421 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018422
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018423and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18424
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018425 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18426 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018427
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018428Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18429
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018430 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018431 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018432 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18433 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18434 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018435 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18436 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18437 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018438 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018439 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18440 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018441 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018442 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18443 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018444 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018445 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018446 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018447 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018448 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018449 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018450 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018451 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18452 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18453 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18454 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18455 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018456 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018457 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018458 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018459 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018460 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018461 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18462 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018463 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18464 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18465 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018466 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018467 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18468 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018469 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018470 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18471 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18472 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018473 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018474 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018475 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18476 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18477 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18478 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018479 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018480 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018481 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018482 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018483 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018484 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018485 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18486 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18487 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018488 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018489 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18490 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018491 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018492 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18493 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018494 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018495 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018496 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018497 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018498
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018499 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018500
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018501
185028.2.5. Error log format
18503-----------------------
18504
18505When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18506protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18507By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18508"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018509will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018510logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18511
18512The format looks like this :
18513
18514 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18515 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18516 Connection error during SSL handshake
18517
18518 Field Format Extract from the example above
18519 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18520 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18521 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18522 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18523 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18524
18525These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18526failures.
18527
18528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185298.3. Advanced logging options
18530-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018531
18532Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18533just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18534options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18535for more information about their usage.
18536
18537
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185388.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18539------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018540
18541It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18542haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18543commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18544monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18545ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18546
18547 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18548 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18549 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18550 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18551
18552 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18553 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18554 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018555 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018556 such as other load-balancers.
18557
18558 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18559 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18560 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18561
18562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185638.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18564----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018565
18566The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18567what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18568or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018569"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018570just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18571log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18572after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18573is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18574with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18575with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18576
18577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185788.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18579------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018580
18581Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18582for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18583"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18584retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18585raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18586a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18587file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18588you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18589"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18590
18591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18593--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018594
18595Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18596multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18597them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18598"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18599logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18600error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18601and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18602too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18603useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18604alternative.
18605
18606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186078.4. Timing events
18608------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018609
18610Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18611reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18612the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18613frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018614mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18615addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18616
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018617Timings events in HTTP mode:
18618
18619 first request 2nd request
18620 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18621 t tr t tr ...
18622 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18623 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18624 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18625 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018626 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018627 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18628
18629Timings events in TCP mode:
18630
18631 TCP session
18632 |<----------------->|
18633 t t
18634 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18635 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18636 |<------ Tt ------->|
18637
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018638 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018639 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018640 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18641 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18642 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018643 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018644 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18645 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18646 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18647 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018648
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018649 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18650 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18651 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018652 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18653 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18654 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18655 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18656 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18657 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018658
18659 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18660 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18661 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18662 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18663 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18664 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18665 request typed by hand during a test.
18666
18667 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18668 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018669 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018670 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18671 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18672 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18673 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018674
18675 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18676 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18677 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18678 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18679 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18680
18681 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18682 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18683 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18684 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18685 connection never established.
18686
18687 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18688 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18689 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18690 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18691 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18692 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18693 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18694 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18695 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18696 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18697 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18698
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018699 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18700 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18701 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18702 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18703 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18704 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18705
18706 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18707
18708 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18709 "Ta" can never be negative.
18710
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018711 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18712 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018713 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18714 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018715 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018716
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018717 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018718
18719 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018720 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18721 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018722
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018723 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
18724 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
18725 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
18726 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
18727 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
18728 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
18729 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
18730 prefixed with a '+' sign.
18731
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018732These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18733protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18734that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018735due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18736"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18737that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018738
18739Most common cases :
18740
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018741 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18742 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18743 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18744 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18745 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18746 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18747 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18748 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18749 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18750 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18751 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018752 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018753
18754 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18755 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18756 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18757 of ms on remote networks.
18758
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018759 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18760 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18761 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018762
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018763 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18764 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18765 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18766 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18767 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18768 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18769 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18770 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18771 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018772
18773Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18774
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018775 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018776 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018777 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018778
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018779 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018780 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18781 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18782
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018783 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018784 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18785 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18786 flags.
18787
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018788 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18789 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018790 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18791 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18792 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18793 the client connection was maintained open.
18794
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018795 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018796 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018797 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018798 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18799
18800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188018.5. Session state at disconnection
18802-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018803
18804TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18805"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
188062-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18807each of which has a special meaning :
18808
18809 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18810 session to terminate :
18811
18812 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18813
18814 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18815 server explicitly refused it.
18816
18817 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18818 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18819 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18820 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018821 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018822
18823 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18824 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018825
18826 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18827 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18828 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18829 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18830 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18831
18832 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18833 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18834 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18835 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18836 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18837
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018838 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18839 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18840
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018841 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18842 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18843 backup connections when going up.
18844
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018845 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18846
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018847 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18848 send or receive data.
18849
18850 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18851 send or receive data.
18852
18853 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18854 with nothing left in the buffers.
18855
18856 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18857
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018858 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018859 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18860
18861 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18862 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18863 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18864 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18865 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18866
18867 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18868 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18869
18870 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18871 server (HTTP only).
18872
18873 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18874
18875 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18876 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18877 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18878
18879 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18880 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18881 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18882
18883 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18884
18885 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18886 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18887
18888 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18889 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18890 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18891
18892 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18893 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018894 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18895 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018896
18897 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18898 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18899 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18900 another server.
18901
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018902 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018903 server.
18904
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018905 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18906 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18907 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18908 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18909
18910 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18911 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18912 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18913 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18914
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018915 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18916 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18917 "use-server" rule).
18918
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018919 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18920
18921 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18922 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18923
18924 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18925
18926 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18927 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18928 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18929
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018930 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18931 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018932 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018933 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18934 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18935
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018936 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18937
18938 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18939 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18940
18941 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18942
18943 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18944
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018945The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18946was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018947helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18948starvation, attacks, etc...
18949
18950The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18951alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18952easier finding and understanding.
18953
18954 Flags Reason
18955
18956 -- Normal termination.
18957
18958 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18959 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18960 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18961 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18962
18963 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18964 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18965 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18966 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18967 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18968 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018969
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018970 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18971 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018972 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018973
18974 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18975 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18976 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18977
18978 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18979 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18980 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18981 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18982 the server takes too long to respond.
18983
18984 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18985 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18986 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18987 long a time to respond.
18988
18989 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18990 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18991 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18992 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018993 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18994 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018995
18996 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18997 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18998 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18999 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19000 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019001 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019002 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19003 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19004 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19005 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19006 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19007 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19008 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19009 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019010 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019011 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19012 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19013 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019014
19015 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19016 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019017 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19018 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19019 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19020 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019021
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019022 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19023 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019025 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019026 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19027 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019028 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019029 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19030 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19031
19032 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19033 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19034 503 or 504 here.
19035
19036 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19037 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19038 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19039 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19040 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19041
19042 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19043 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019044 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019045 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19046 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19047
19048 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19049 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19050 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19051 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19052 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19053 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19054 between haproxy and the server.
19055
19056 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19057 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19058 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19059 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19060 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19061 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19062 solution is to fix the application.
19063
19064 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19065 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19066 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19067 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19068 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19069 external attacks.
19070
19071 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19072 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019073 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019074 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19075 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19076
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019077 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19078 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19079 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019080 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019081 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019082
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019083 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19084 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19085 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19086 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019087 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19088 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19089 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19090 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19091 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019092
19093 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19094 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19095 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19096 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19097
19098 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19099 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19100 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19101 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19102
19103 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19104 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19105 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19106 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19107
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019108The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19109persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19110important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19111re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19112
19113 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19114
19115 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19116 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19117 set on a GET request.
19118
19119 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19120 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019121 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019122 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19123
19124 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19125 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19126 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19127
19128 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19129 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19130 already got a cookie.
19131
19132 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19133 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19134 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19135 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19136 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19137
19138 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19139 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19140 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19141
19142 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19143 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19144 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19145
19146 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19147 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19148
19149 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19150 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19151 then advertised in the response.
19152
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191548.6. Non-printable characters
19155-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019156
19157In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19158consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19159converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19160prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19161being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19162escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19163is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19164'}' when logging headers.
19165
19166Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19167issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19168containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19169
19170Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19171the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19172performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19173
19174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191758.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19176---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019177
19178Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19179achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019180section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019181cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19182the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19183the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019184locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019185not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19186user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19187a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19188wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19189
19190 Examples :
19191 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19192 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19193
19194 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19195 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19196
19197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191988.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19199---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019200
19201Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19202proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19203the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19204server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19205
19206Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19207response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019208section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019209
19210It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019211time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19212appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019213are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19214and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19215follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19216request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19217in the logs.
19218
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019219As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19220frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19221an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19222
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019223 Example :
19224 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19225 listen proxy-out
19226 mode http
19227 option httplog
19228 option logasap
19229 log global
19230 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19231
19232 # log the name of the virtual server
19233 capture request header Host len 20
19234
19235 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19236 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19237
19238 # log the beginning of the referrer
19239 capture request header Referer len 20
19240
19241 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19242 capture response header Server len 20
19243
19244 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19245 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19246
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019247 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019248 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19249
19250 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19251 capture response header Via len 20
19252
19253 # log the URL location during a redirection
19254 capture response header Location len 20
19255
19256 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19257 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19258 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19259 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19260 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19261
19262 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19263 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19264 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19265 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019266 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019267
19268 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19269 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19270 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19271 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19272 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019273 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019274
19275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192768.9. Examples of logs
19277---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019278
19279These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19280them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19281reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19282
19283 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19284 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19285 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19286
19287 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19288 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19289
19290 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19291 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19292 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19293
19294 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19295 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19296
19297 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19298 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19299 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19300
19301 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019302 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019303 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19304 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19305
19306 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19307 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19308 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19309
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019310 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19311 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19312 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19313 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19314 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19315 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019316
19317 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019318 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019319
19320 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19321 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19322 Nothing was sent to any server.
19323
19324 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19325 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19326
19327 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19328 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019329 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019330 send a 408 return code to the client.
19331
19332 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19333 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19334
19335 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19336 5 seconds ("c----").
19337
19338 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19339 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019340 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019341
19342 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019343 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019344 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19345 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19346 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19347 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19348 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019349
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019350
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200193519. Supported filters
19352--------------------
19353
19354Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19355accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19356unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19357
19358See also : "filter"
19359
193609.1. Trace
19361----------
19362
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019363filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019364
19365 Arguments:
19366 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19367 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19368
19369 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19370 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19371 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19372 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019374 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019375 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19376 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19377 amount of the parsed data.
19378
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019379 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019380
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019381This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19382callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19383information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19384filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19385
19386Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19387tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19388a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19389
19390
193919.2. HTTP compression
19392---------------------
19393
19394filter compression
19395
19396The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19397keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019398when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19399fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19400done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19401explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19402filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19403listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19404order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019405
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019406See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19407 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019408
19409
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200194109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19411--------------------------------------------
19412
19413filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19414
19415 Arguments :
19416
19417 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19418 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19419 parsed.
19420
19421 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19422 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19423 part must be placed in its own scope.
19424
19425The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19426external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019427streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019428exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19429also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19430
19431SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19432the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19433
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019434For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019435"doc/SPOE.txt".
19436
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100194379.4. Cache
19438----------
19439
19440filter cache <name>
19441
19442 Arguments :
19443
19444 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19445
19446The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19447"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019448cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019449other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19450case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19451is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19452filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019453listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19454order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019455
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019456See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19457 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19458
19459
194609.5. Fcgi-app
19461-------------
19462
19463filter fcg-app <name>
19464
19465 Arguments :
19466
19467 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19468
19469The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19470request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19471reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19472used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19473implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19474used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19475fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19476used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19477order.
19478
19479See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19480 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19481
19482
1948310. FastCGI applications
19484-------------------------
19485
19486HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19487feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19488the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19489FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19490servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19491FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19492backend.
19493
19494HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19495application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19496connection.
19497
1949810.1. Setup
19499-----------
19500
1950110.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19502--------------------------
19503
19504fcgi-app <name>
19505 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19506 document root must be defined.
19507
19508acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19509 Declare or complete an access list.
19510
19511 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19512 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19513 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19514 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19515 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19516
19517docroot <path>
19518 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19519 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19520 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19521
19522index <script-name>
19523 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19524 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19525 is an optional setting.
19526
19527 Example :
19528 index index.php
19529
19530log-stderr global
19531log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19532 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19533 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19534
19535 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19536 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19537
19538pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19539 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19540 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19541 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19542
19543 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19544 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19545 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19546 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19547
19548 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19549 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19550
19551path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019552 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019553 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19554 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19555 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19556 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19557 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19558 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19559 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019560
19561 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019562 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019563 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19564 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19565 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19566 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019567
19568 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019569 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19570 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019571
19572option get-values
19573no option get-values
19574 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19575
19576 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19577 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19578
19579 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19580 application will accept.
19581
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019582 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19583 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019584
19585 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19586 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19587 option is disabled.
19588
19589 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19590 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19591 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19592 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19593 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19594 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19595
19596option keep-conn
19597no option keep-conn
19598 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19599 sending a response.
19600
19601 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19602 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19603
19604option max-reqs <reqs>
19605 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19606 accept.
19607
19608 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19609 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19610 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19611 to 1.
19612
19613option mpxs-conns
19614no option mpxs-conns
19615 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19616
19617 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19618 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19619
19620set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19621 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19622 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19623 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19624 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19625
19626 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19627 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19628 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19629
19630 Example :
19631 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19632 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19633
19634 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19635
19636
1963710.1.2. Proxy section
19638---------------------
19639
19640use-fcgi-app <name>
19641 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19642
19643 Arguments :
19644 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19645
19646 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19647 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19648 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19649 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19650 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19651
19652 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19653 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19654 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19655 application are evaluated.
19656
19657
1965810.1.3. Example
19659---------------
19660
19661 frontend front-http
19662 mode http
19663 bind *:80
19664 bind *:
19665
19666 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19667 default_backend back-static
19668
19669 backend back-static
19670 mode http
19671 server www A.B.C.D:80
19672
19673 backend back-dynamic
19674 mode http
19675 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19676 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19677
19678 fcgi-app php-fpm
19679 log-stderr global
19680 option keep-conn
19681
19682 docroot /var/www/my-app
19683 index index.php
19684 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19685
19686
1968710.2. Default parameters
19688------------------------
19689
19690A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19691the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019692script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019693applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19694
19695 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19696 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19697 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19698 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19699 | | |
19700 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19701 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19702 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19703 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19704 | | application. |
19705 | | |
19706 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19707 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19708 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19709 | | |
19710 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19711 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19712 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19713 | | the application's configuration. |
19714 | | |
19715 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19716 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19717 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19718 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19719 | | |
19720 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19721 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19722 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19723 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19724 | | be defined. |
19725 | | |
19726 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19727 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19728 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19729 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19730 | | is not set too. |
19731 | | |
19732 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19733 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19734 | | set. |
19735 | | |
19736 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19737 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19738 | | the request. |
19739 | | |
19740 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19741 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19742 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19743 | | |
19744 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19745 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19746 | | script to process the request. |
19747 | | |
19748 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19749 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19750 | | |
19751 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19752 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19753 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19754 | | |
19755 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19756 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19757 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19758 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19759 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19760 | | |
19761 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19762 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19763 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19764 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19765 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19766 | | side. |
19767 | | |
19768 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19769 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19770 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19771 | | connected to. |
19772 | | |
19773 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19774 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19775 | | |
19776 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19777 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19778 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19779 | | |
19780 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19781
19782
1978310.3. Limitations
19784------------------
19785
19786The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19787way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19788during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19789establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19790application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19791or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19792message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19793these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19794and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19795
19796Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19797request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19798requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19799
19800About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19801into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19802fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19803"http-request" ones.
19804
19805Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19806FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19807processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19808must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19809here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019810
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019811/*
19812 * Local variables:
19813 * fill-column: 79
19814 * End:
19815 */